blob: 16fd28e4615e056cb349d09cc9702b50c028c806 [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000024#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
25#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034#include <algorithm>
35
36namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000037using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000038
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000039/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
42 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000043 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
44 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000045 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000046 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
47 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
48 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000049
50 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
51 S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc);
52
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000053 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000054 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
55 if (E.isInvalid())
56 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000057 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000058}
59
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000060static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
61 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000062 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000063 bool CStyle,
64 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000065
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000066static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
67 QualType &ToType,
68 bool InOverloadResolution,
69 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
70 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000071static OverloadingResult
72IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
73 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
74 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
75 bool AllowExplicit);
76
77
78static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
79CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
82
83static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
84CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
86 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
87
88static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
89CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
90 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
91 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
92
93
94
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000095/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
96/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000097ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000098GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
99 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
100 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
101 ICC_Identity,
102 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
103 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
104 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000105 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
107 ICC_Promotion,
108 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000109 ICC_Promotion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
115 ICC_Conversion,
116 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000117 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000118 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000119 ICC_Conversion,
120 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000121 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000122 ICC_Conversion
123 };
124 return Category[(int)Kind];
125}
126
127/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
128/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
129ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
130 static const ImplicitConversionRank
131 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
132 ICR_Exact_Match,
133 ICR_Exact_Match,
134 ICR_Exact_Match,
135 ICR_Exact_Match,
136 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000137 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000138 ICR_Promotion,
139 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000140 ICR_Promotion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000149 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000150 ICR_Conversion,
151 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000152 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000154 ICR_Conversion,
155 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000156 };
157 return Rank[(int)Kind];
158}
159
160/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
161/// implicit conversion.
162const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000163 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "No conversion",
165 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
166 "Array-to-pointer",
167 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000168 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000169 "Qualification",
170 "Integral promotion",
171 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000172 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 "Integral conversion",
174 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000175 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000176 "Floating-integral conversion",
177 "Pointer conversion",
178 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000179 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000180 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000181 "Derived-to-base conversion",
182 "Vector conversion",
183 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000184 "Complex-real conversion",
185 "Block Pointer conversion",
186 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000187 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000188 };
189 return Name[Kind];
190}
191
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000192/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
193/// sequence to the identity conversion.
194void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
195 First = ICK_Identity;
196 Second = ICK_Identity;
197 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000198 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000199 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000200 ReferenceBinding = false;
201 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000202 IsLvalueReference = true;
203 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
204 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000205 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000206 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000207 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000208}
209
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
211/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
212/// implicit conversions.
213ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
214 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
215 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
216 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
217 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
218 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
219 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
220 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
221 return Rank;
222}
223
224/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
225/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000226/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000227/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000228bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
230 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
231 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
232 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000233 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000234 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000237 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
239 return true;
240
241 return false;
242}
243
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
245/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
246/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
247/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000249StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000250isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000251 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000252 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253
254 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
255 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
256 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
257 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
258 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
259
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000260 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000261 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000262 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
263
264 return false;
265}
266
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000267/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
268/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
269static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
270 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
271 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
272 case CK_NoOp:
273 case CK_IntegralCast:
274 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
275 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
276 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
277 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
278 case CK_FloatingCast:
279 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
280 continue;
281
282 default:
283 return Converted;
284 }
285 }
286
287 return Converted;
288}
289
290/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
291/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
292///
293/// \param Ctx The AST context.
294/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
295/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
296/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000297/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
298/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000299NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000300StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
301 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000302 APValue &ConstantValue,
303 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000304 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000305
306 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
307 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
308 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
309 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
310 switch (Second) {
311 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
312 //
313 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
314 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
315 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
316 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
317 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
318 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
319 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
320 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
321 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
322 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
323 if (Initializer &&
324 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
325 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
326 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
327 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
328 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
329 // And back.
330 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
331 bool ignored;
332 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
333 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
334 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
335 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
336 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000337 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000338 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
339 }
340 } else {
341 // Variables are always narrowings.
342 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
343 }
344 }
345 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
346
347 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
348 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
349 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
350 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
351 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
352 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
353 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
354 // FromType is larger than ToType.
355 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
356 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
357 // Constant!
358 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
359 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
360 // Convert the source value into the target type.
361 bool ignored;
362 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
363 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
364 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
365 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
366 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000367 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
368 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000369 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000370 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000371 } else {
372 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
373 }
374 }
375 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
376
377 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
378 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
379 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
380 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
381 // value when converted back to the original type.
382 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
383 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
384 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
385 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
386 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
387 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
388 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
389 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
390 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
391 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
392 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
393 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
394 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
395
396 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000397 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
398 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000399 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
400 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
401 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000402 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
403 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
404 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000405 }
406 bool Narrowing = false;
407 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000408 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
409 // narrowing.
410 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000411 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000412 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000413 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
414 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
415 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
416 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
417 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
418 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
419 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
420 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
421 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
422 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
423 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000424 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
425 Narrowing = true;
426 }
427 if (Narrowing) {
428 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
429 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
430 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000431 }
432 }
433 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
434 }
435
436 default:
437 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
438 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
439 }
440}
441
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
443/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
444void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000445 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000446 bool PrintedSomething = false;
447 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000448 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000449 PrintedSomething = true;
450 }
451
452 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
453 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000456 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000457
458 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000459 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000460 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000461 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000462 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000463 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000464 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 PrintedSomething = true;
466 }
467
468 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
469 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000470 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000471 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000473 PrintedSomething = true;
474 }
475
476 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000477 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000478 }
479}
480
481/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
482/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
483void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000484 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000485 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
486 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000487 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000488 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000489 if (ConversionFunction)
490 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
491 else
492 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000493 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000494 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 After.DebugPrint();
496 }
497}
498
499/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
500/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
501void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000502 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000503 switch (ConversionKind) {
504 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000505 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000506 Standard.DebugPrint();
507 break;
508 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000509 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000510 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
511 break;
512 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000513 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000514 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000515 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000516 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000517 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000518 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000519 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000520 break;
521 }
522
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000523 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000524}
525
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000526void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
527 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
528}
529
530void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
531 conversions().~ConversionSet();
532}
533
534void
535AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
536 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
537 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
538 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
539}
540
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000541namespace {
542 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000543 // template argument information.
544 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000545 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
546 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
547 };
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000548 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
549 // template parameter and template argument information.
550 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
551 TemplateParameter Param;
552 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000554
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
556/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
557OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000558static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
559 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000560 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000561 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
562 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000563 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 Result.Data = 0;
565 switch (TDK) {
566 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000567 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000568 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000569 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
570 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000571 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000572
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000574 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
576 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000577
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000578 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
579 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
580 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
581 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
582 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
583 Result.Data = Saved;
584 break;
585 }
586
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000588 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000589 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
590 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000591 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
592 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
593 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
594 Result.Data = Saved;
595 break;
596 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000597
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000598 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000599 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000600 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
601 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
602 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
603 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
604 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
605 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000606 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000607
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000609 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
610 break;
611
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000612 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000613 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000614 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000615
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return Result;
617}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000618
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
620 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
621 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000622 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000623 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
624 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
626 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000627 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000628 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000629 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000630
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000631 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000632 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000633 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000634 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000635 Data = 0;
636 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000637
638 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000639 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000640 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000641 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
642 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
643 HasDiagnostic = false;
644 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000645 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000646
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000647 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000648 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 break;
650 }
651}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000652
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000653PartialDiagnosticAt *
654OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
655 if (HasDiagnostic)
656 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
657 return 0;
658}
659
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000660TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
662 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
663 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000665 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000666 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
667 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
670 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000671 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000674 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000675 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000676
677 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000678 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000679 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000680
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000681 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000683 break;
684 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000685
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return TemplateParameter();
687}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000688
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000689TemplateArgumentList *
690OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
691 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000692 case Sema::TDK_Success:
693 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
694 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
695 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
696 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
697 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
698 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
699 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
700 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
701 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
702 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
703 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000704
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000705 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
706 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000707
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000708 // Unhandled
709 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
710 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000711 }
712
713 return 0;
714}
715
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000716const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
717 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
718 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000719 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000720 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
721 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000722 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
723 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000724 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000725 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000726 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000727 return 0;
728
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
732 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000733
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000734 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 break;
737 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000738
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000739 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000740}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000741
742const TemplateArgument *
743OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
744 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
745 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000746 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000747 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
748 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000749 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
750 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000751 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000752 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000753 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000754 return 0;
755
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000757 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
759 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000760
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000761 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000763 break;
764 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000765
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000766 return 0;
767}
768
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000769Expr *
770OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
771 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
772 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
773 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
774
775 return 0;
776}
777
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000778void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000779 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000780 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
781 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000782 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
783 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
784 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000785}
786
787void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
788 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000789 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000790 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000791 Functions.clear();
792}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000793
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000794namespace {
795 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
796 struct Entry {
797 Expr **Addr;
798 Expr *Saved;
799 };
800 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
801
802 public:
803 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
804 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
805 Entry entry = { &E, E };
806 Entries.push_back(entry);
807 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
808 }
809
810 void restore() {
811 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
812 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
813 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
814 }
815 };
816}
817
818/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
819/// preprocessing on the given expression.
820///
821/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
822/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
823///
824/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
825static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
826 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000827 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
828 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
829 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
830 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
831
832 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
833 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
834 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
835 unbridgedCasts) {
836 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
837 return false;
838 }
839
840 // Go ahead and check everything else.
841 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
842 if (result.isInvalid())
843 return true;
844
845 E = result.take();
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Nothing to do.
850 return false;
851}
852
853/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
854/// placeholders.
855static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
856 unsigned numArgs,
857 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
858 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
859 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
860 return true;
861
862 return false;
863}
864
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000865// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000866// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
867// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
868// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
869// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000870// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
871// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
872// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000873//
874// Example: Given the following input:
875//
876// void f(int, float); // #1
877// void f(int, int); // #2
878// int f(int, int); // #3
879//
880// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000881// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000883// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
884// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
885// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
886// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000887//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000888// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
889// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
890// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
891// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000892// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
893// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000894//
895// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
896// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
897// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
898// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000899Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000900Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
901 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000902 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000903 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000904 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
905
906 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
907 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
908 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
909
910 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
911 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
912 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
913
914 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
915 }
916
917 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
918 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
919 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
920 // function templates hide function templates with different
921 // return types or template parameter lists.
922 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
923 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
924
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000925 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000926 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
927 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
928 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
929 continue;
930 }
931
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000932 Match = *I;
933 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000934 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000935 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000942 Match = *I;
943 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000944 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000945 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000946 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
947 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
948 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000949 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
950 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000951 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
952 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
953 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
954 // template instantiation.
955 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000956 // (C++ 13p1):
957 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
958 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000959 Match = *I;
960 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000961 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000962 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000963
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000964 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000965}
966
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000967static bool canBeOverloaded(const FunctionDecl &D) {
968 if (D.getAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
969 return true;
Rafael Espindolad2fdd422013-02-14 01:47:04 +0000970 if (D.isExternC())
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000971 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000972
973 // Main cannot be overloaded (basic.start.main).
974 if (D.isMain())
975 return false;
976
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000977 return true;
978}
979
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000980bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
981 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000982 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
983 // overloads.
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000984 if (!canBeOverloaded(*Old) && !canBeOverloaded(*New))
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000985 return false;
986
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000987 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
988 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
989
990 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
991 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
992 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
993 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
994 return true;
995
996 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
997 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
998 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
999
1000 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1001 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1002 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1003
1004 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1005 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1006 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1007 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1008 return false;
1009
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001010 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1011 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001012
1013 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1014 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1015 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1016 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1017 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1018 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001019 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001020 return true;
1021
1022 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1023 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1024 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1025 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1026 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1027 // signature.
1028 //
1029 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1030 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001031 //
1032 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1033 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1034 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001035 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1036 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1037 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1038 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1039 return true;
1040
1041 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001042 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001043 //
1044 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1045 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1046 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1047 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1048 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001049 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1050 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001051 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001052 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1053 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1054 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1055 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1056 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1057 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1058 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1059 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1060 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1061 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1062 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1063 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1064 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1065 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1066 }
1067 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001068 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001069
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001070 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1071 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1072 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1073 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1074 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith714fcc12013-01-14 08:00:39 +00001075 if (NewMethod->isConstexpr() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001076 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1077 if (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewQuals)
1078 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001079 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001080
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001081 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1082 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001083}
1084
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001085/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1086/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1087///
1088/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1089/// an available function, false otherwise.
1090bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1091 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1092}
1093
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001094/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1095///
1096/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1097/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1098static ImplicitConversionSequence
1099TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1100 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1101 bool AllowExplicit,
1102 bool InOverloadResolution,
1103 bool CStyle,
1104 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1105 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1106
1107 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1108 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1109 // we can perform.
1110 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1111 return ICS;
1112 }
1113
1114 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1115 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1116 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1117 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1118 AllowExplicit);
1119
1120 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1121 ICS.setUserDefined();
1122 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1123 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1124 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1125 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1126 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1127 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1128 // called for those cases.
1129 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1130 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1131 QualType FromCanon
1132 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1133 QualType ToCanon
1134 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1135 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1136 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1137 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1138 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1139 ICS.setStandard();
1140 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1141 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1142 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1143 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1144 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1145 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1146 }
1147 }
1148
1149 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1150 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1151 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1152 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1153 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1154 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1155 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1156 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1157 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1158 }
1159 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1160 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1161 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1162 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1163 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1164 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1165 if (Cand->Viable)
1166 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1167 } else {
1168 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1169 }
1170
1171 return ICS;
1172}
1173
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001174/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1175/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1176/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1177/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001178///
1179/// void f(float f);
1180/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1181///
1182/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1183/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1184/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1185/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1186//
1187/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1188/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1189/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1190/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1191/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001192///
1193/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1194/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001195/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1196/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001197///
1198/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1199/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1200/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001201static ImplicitConversionSequence
1202TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1203 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001204 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001205 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001206 bool CStyle,
1207 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001208 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001210 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001211 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001212 return ICS;
1213 }
1214
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001215 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001216 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001217 return ICS;
1218 }
1219
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001220 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1221 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1222 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1223 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1224 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1225 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1226 // called for those cases.
1227 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1228 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001229 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1230 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001231 ICS.setStandard();
1232 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1233 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1234 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001235
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001236 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1237 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1238 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1239 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1240 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001241
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001242 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001244 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001245
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001246 return ICS;
1247 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001249 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1250 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1251 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001252}
1253
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001254ImplicitConversionSequence
1255Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1256 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1257 bool AllowExplicit,
1258 bool InOverloadResolution,
1259 bool CStyle,
1260 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1261 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1262 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1263 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1264 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001265}
1266
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001267/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001268/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001269/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1270/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1271/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001272ExprResult
1273Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001274 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001275 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001276 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001277}
1278
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279ExprResult
1280Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001281 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001282 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001283 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1284 return ExprError();
1285
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001286 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1287 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001288 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001289 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001290
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001291 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1292 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1293 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001294 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001295 /*CStyle=*/false,
1296 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001297 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1298}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001299
1300/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001301/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001302bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1303 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001304 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1305 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001306
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001307 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1308 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1309 // - a pointer
1310 // - a member pointer
1311 // - a block pointer
1312 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1313 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1314 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1315 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1316 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1317 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1318 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1319 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1320 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1321 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1322 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1323 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1324 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1325 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1326 } else {
1327 return false;
1328 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001329
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001330 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1331 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1332 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1333 return false;
1334 }
1335
1336 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1337 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1338 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1339
1340 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1341 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1342 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1343
1344 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001345 return true;
1346}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001347
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001348/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1349/// vector conversion.
1350///
1351/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1352/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001353static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1354 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001355 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1356 // conversion.
1357 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1358 return false;
1359
1360 // Identical types require no conversions.
1361 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1362 return false;
1363
1364 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1365 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1366 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1367 // identity conversion.
1368 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1369 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001370
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001371 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001372 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001373 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1374 return true;
1375 }
1376 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001377
1378 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1379 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1380 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1381 // same size
1382 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1383 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001384 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001385 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001386 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1387 return true;
1388 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001389 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001390
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001391 return false;
1392}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001393
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001394static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1395 bool InOverloadResolution,
1396 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1397 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001398
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001399/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1400/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1401/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1402/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1403/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1404/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1405/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1406/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001407static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1408 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001409 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001410 bool CStyle,
1411 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001412 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001413
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001415 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001416 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001417 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001418 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001419 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001420
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001421 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001422 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001423 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001424 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001425 return false;
1426
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001427 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001428 }
1429
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001430 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1431 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1432 // (C++ 4p1).
1433
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001435 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1436 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001437 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001439 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1440 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1441 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001442
1443 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1444 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1445 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1446 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1447 QualType resultTy;
1448 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001449 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001450 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1451 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1452 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1453 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001454 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001455
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001456 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1457 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1458 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1459 // expression.
1460 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1461 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1462 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1463 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1464 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1465 == UO_AddrOf &&
1466 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1467 const Type *ClassType
1468 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1469 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001470 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1471 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1472 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001473 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1474 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1475 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001476
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001477 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001478 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1479 FromType,
1480 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001481 } else {
1482 return false;
1483 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001484 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001485 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1486 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1487 // be converted to a prvalue.
1488 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001489 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001490 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001491 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001493
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001494 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1495 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1496 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1497 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1498 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1499
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001500 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1501 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001502 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1503 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001504 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001505 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1506 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001507 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001508
1509 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1510 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1511 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001512 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001513
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001514 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001516 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001517
1518 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1519 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1520 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1521 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001522 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1523 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001525 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001526 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001527 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001528 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001529 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001530 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001531
1532 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1533 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1534 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001535 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001536 } else {
1537 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001538 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001539 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001540 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001541
1542 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1543 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1544 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1545 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001546 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1547 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001548 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001549 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001550 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1552 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001553 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001554 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001555 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001558 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001559 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001560 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001561 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001562 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001563 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001564 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1565 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001566 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1567 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1568 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1569 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1570 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1571 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1572 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1573 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1574 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001575 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001576 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001577 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001578 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001579 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001580 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001581 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001582 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1583 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001584 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1585 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001586 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1587 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1588 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001589 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001590 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1591 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1592 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001593 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001594 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001595 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001596 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001597 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001598 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001599 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001600 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001601 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1602 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1603 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1604 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001605 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1606 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001607 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001608 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001609 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001610 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001611 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001612 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001613 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001614 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001615 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001616 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1617 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001618 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001619 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001620 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001621 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001622 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001623 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001624 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1625 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001626 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1627 InOverloadResolution,
1628 SCS, CStyle)) {
1629 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1630 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001631 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1632 CStyle)) {
1633 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001634 // appropriately.
1635 return true;
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001636 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1637 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1638 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1639 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1640 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001641 } else {
1642 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001643 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001644 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001645 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001646
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001647 QualType CanonFrom;
1648 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001649 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001650 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1651 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1652 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001653 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001654 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001656 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1657 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001658 } else {
1659 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001660 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1661
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001662 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001663 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1664 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1665 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001666 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1667 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001668 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001669 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault5509f372013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001670 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001671 FromType = ToType;
1672 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1673 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001674 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001675 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001676
1677 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1678 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001679 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001680 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001681
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001682 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001683}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001684
1685static bool
1686IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1687 QualType &ToType,
1688 bool InOverloadResolution,
1689 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1690 bool CStyle) {
1691
1692 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1693 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1694 return false;
1695 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1696 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1697 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1698 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1699 itend = UD->field_end();
1700 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001701 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1702 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001703 ToType = it->getType();
1704 return true;
1705 }
1706 }
1707 return false;
1708}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001709
1710/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1711/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1712/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1713/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001714bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001715 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001716 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001717 if (!To) {
1718 return false;
1719 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001720
1721 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1722 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1723 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1724 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1725 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001726 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1727 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001728 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1729 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1730 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1731 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001732 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001733 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001734 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001735 }
1736
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001737 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1738 }
1739
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001740 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001741 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1742 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1743 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1744 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1745 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001746 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001747 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001748 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001749 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1750 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001751 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001752 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1753 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1754 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1755 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1756 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1757 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001758 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1759 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1760 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1761 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1762 return false;
1763
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001764 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1765 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1766 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1767 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1768 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1769 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1770 }
1771
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001772 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001773 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001774 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001775 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1776 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001777 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001778
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001779 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001780 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1781 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1782 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001783 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001785 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001786 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001787 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001788 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001789 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001790 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1791 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001792 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001793 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001794
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001795 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1796 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001797 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1798 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001799 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1800 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001801 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001802 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001803 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1804 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001805 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001806 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1807 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1808 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1809 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001810 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001811 }
1812 }
1813 }
1814
1815 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1816 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1817 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1818 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1819 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1820 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1821 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001822 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1823 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001824 using llvm::APSInt;
1825 if (From)
1826 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001827 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001828 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001829 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1830 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1831 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001832
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001833 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1834 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1835 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1836 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1837 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001838
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001839 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1840 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1841 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1842 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1843 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001844
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001845 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001846 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001847 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001848
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001849 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1850 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001851 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001852 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001853 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001854
1855 return false;
1856}
1857
1858/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1859/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1860/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001861bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001862 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1863 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001864 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1865 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001866 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1867 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1868 return true;
1869
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001870 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1871 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1872 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001873 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001874 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1875 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1876 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1877 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001878
1879 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001880 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1881 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001882 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1883 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001884 }
1885
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001886 return false;
1887}
1888
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001889/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1890///
1891/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1892/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001893/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001894bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001895 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001896 if (!FromComplex)
1897 return false;
1898
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001899 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001900 if (!ToComplex)
1901 return false;
1902
1903 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001904 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1905 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1906 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001907}
1908
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001909/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1910/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1911/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1912/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1913/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001914///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001915static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001916BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001917 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001918 ASTContext &Context,
1919 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001920 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1921 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1922 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001923
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001924 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1925 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001926 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001927
1928 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001929 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001930 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001931 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001932
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001933 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1934 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1935
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001936 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001937 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001938 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001939 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001940 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001941
1942 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1943 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001944 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1945 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001946 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1947 }
1948
1949 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001950 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1951 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001952
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001953 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1954 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1955 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001956}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001957
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001958static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001959 bool InOverloadResolution,
1960 ASTContext &Context) {
1961 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1962 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1963 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001964 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001965 return !InOverloadResolution;
1966
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001967 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1968 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1969 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001970}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001971
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001972/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1973/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1974/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1975/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1976/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1977/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001978///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001979/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1980/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1981/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1982/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1983/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1984/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001985/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1986/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1987/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001988bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001989 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001990 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001991 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001992 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001993 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1994 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001995 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001996
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001997 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1998 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001999 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002000 ConvertedType = ToType;
2001 return true;
2002 }
2003
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002004 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2005 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002006 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002007 ConvertedType = ToType;
2008 return true;
2009 }
2010 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2011 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002012 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002013 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002014 ConvertedType = ToType;
2015 return true;
2016 }
2017
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002018 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2019 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002020 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002021 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002022 ConvertedType = ToType;
2023 return true;
2024 }
2025
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002026 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002027 if (!ToTypePtr)
2028 return false;
2029
2030 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002031 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002032 ConvertedType = ToType;
2033 return true;
2034 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002035
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002036 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002037 // , including objective-c pointers.
2038 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002039 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002040 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002041 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2042 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2043 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002044 ToType, Context);
2045 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002046 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002047 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002048 if (!FromTypePtr)
2049 return false;
2050
2051 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002052
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002053 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002054 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2055 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2056 return false;
2057
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002058 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2059 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2060 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002061 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2062 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002063 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002064 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002065 ToType, Context,
2066 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002067 return true;
2068 }
2069
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002070 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002071 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002072 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2073 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2074 ToPointeeType,
2075 ToType, Context);
2076 return true;
2077 }
2078
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002079 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2080 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002081 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002082 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002083 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002084 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002085 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002086 return true;
2087 }
2088
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002089 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002090 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002091 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2092 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2093 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2094 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2095 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2096 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2097 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2098 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2099 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002100 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2101 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002102 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002103 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002104 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002105 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002106 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002108 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002109 ToType, Context);
2110 return true;
2111 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002112
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002113 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2114 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2115 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2116 ToPointeeType,
2117 ToType, Context);
2118 return true;
2119 }
2120
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002121 return false;
2122}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002123
2124/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2125static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2126 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2127
2128 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2129 if (TQs == Qs)
2130 return T;
2131
2132 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2133 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2134
2135 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2136}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002137
2138/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2139/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2140/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002141bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002142 QualType& ConvertedType,
2143 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002144 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002145 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002146
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002147 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2148 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2149
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002150 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002151 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2152 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002154 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002155
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002156 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002157 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2158 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2159 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2160 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2161 return false;
2162
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002163 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002164 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002165 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002166 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002167 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002168 return true;
2169 }
2170 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002171 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002172 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002173 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002174 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002175 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002176 return true;
2177 }
2178 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2179 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2180 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002181 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2182 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002183 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002184 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2185 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2186 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002187 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002188 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2189 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002190 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002191 return true;
2192 }
2193
2194 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2195 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2196 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2197 // complain about it.
2198 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002199 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002200 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2201 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002202 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002203 return true;
2204 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002205 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002206 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002207 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002208 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002209 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002210 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002211 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002212 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002213 // to a block pointer type.
2214 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002215 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002216 return true;
2217 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002218 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002219 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002220 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002221 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002222 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002223 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002224 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002225 return true;
2226 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002227 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002228 return false;
2229
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002230 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002231 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002232 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002233 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2234 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002235 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2236 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002237 return false;
2238
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002239 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2240 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2241 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2242 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2243 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2244 // We always complain about this conversion.
2245 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002246 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002247 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002248 return true;
2249 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002250 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2251 // as in I* to id.
2252 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2253 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2254 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2255 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002256
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002257 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002258 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002259 return true;
2260 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002261
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002262 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002263 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2264 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2265 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002266 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002267 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002268 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002269 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002270 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2271 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2272 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2273 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2274 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2275 return false;
2276
2277 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2278 // function types are obviously different.
2279 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2280 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2281 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2282 return false;
2283
2284 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2285 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2286 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2287 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2288 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2289 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2290 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2291 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2292 HasObjCConversion = true;
2293 } else {
2294 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2295 return false;
2296 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002297
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002298 // Check argument types.
2299 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2300 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2301 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2302 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2303 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2304 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2305 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2306 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2307 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2308 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2309 HasObjCConversion = true;
2310 } else {
2311 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2312 return false;
2313 }
2314 }
2315
2316 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2317 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2318 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002319 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002320 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2321 return true;
2322 }
2323 }
2324
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002325 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002326}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002327
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002328/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2329/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2330///
2331/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2332///
2333/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2334///
2335/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2336/// this conversion.
2337bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2338 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002339 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002340 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2341 return false;
2342
2343 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2344 QualType ToPointee;
2345 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2346 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2347 else
2348 return false;
2349
2350 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2351 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2352 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002353 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002354 return false;
2355
2356 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2357 QualType FromPointee;
2358 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2359 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2360 else
2361 return false;
2362
2363 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2364 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2365 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2366 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2367 return false;
2368
2369 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2370 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2371 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2372 return false;
2373
2374 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2375 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2376 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2377 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2378
2379 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2380 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2381 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2382 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2383 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2384 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2385 IncompatibleObjC))
2386 return false;
2387
2388 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2389 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2390 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2391 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2392 return true;
2393}
2394
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002395bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2396 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2397 QualType ToPointeeType;
2398 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2399 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2400 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2401 else
2402 return false;
2403
2404 QualType FromPointeeType;
2405 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2406 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2407 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2408 else
2409 return false;
2410 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2411 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2412 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2413
2414 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2415 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2416 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2417 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2418
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002419 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2420 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002421
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002422 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002423 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002424
2425 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2426 // function types are obviously different.
2427 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2428 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2429 return false;
2430
2431 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2432 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2433 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2434 return false;
2435
2436 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002437 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2438 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002439 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2440 } else {
2441 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2442 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002443 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002444 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2445 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2446
2447 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2448 // OK exact match.
2449 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2450 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2451 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2452 return false;
2453 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2454 }
2455 else
2456 return false;
2457 }
2458
2459 // Check argument types.
2460 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2461 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2462 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2463 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2464 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2465 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2466 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2467 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2468 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2469 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2470 return false;
2471 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2472 } else
2473 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2474 return false;
2475 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002476 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2477 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2478 ToFunctionType))
2479 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002480
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002481 ConvertedType = ToType;
2482 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002483}
2484
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002485enum {
2486 ft_default,
2487 ft_different_class,
2488 ft_parameter_arity,
2489 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2490 ft_return_type,
2491 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2492};
2493
2494/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2495/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2496/// parameter types, and different return types.
2497void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2498 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002499 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2500 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2501 PDiag << ft_default;
2502 return;
2503 }
2504
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002505 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2506 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2507 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2508 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2509 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2510 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2511 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2512 return;
2513 }
2514 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2515 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002516 }
2517
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002518 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2519 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2520 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2521 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2522
2523 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002524 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2525 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2526
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002527 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2528 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2529 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2530 PDiag << ft_default;
2531 return;
2532 }
2533
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002534 // No extra info for same types.
2535 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2536 PDiag << ft_default;
2537 return;
2538 }
2539
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002540 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2541 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2542
2543 // Both types need to be function types.
2544 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2545 PDiag << ft_default;
2546 return;
2547 }
2548
2549 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2550 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2551 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2552 return;
2553 }
2554
2555 // Handle different parameter types.
2556 unsigned ArgPos;
2557 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2558 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2559 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2560 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2561 return;
2562 }
2563
2564 // Handle different return type.
2565 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2566 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2567 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2568 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2569 return;
2570 }
2571
2572 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2573 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2574 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2575 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2576 return;
2577 }
2578
2579 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2580 PDiag << ft_default;
2581}
2582
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002583/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002584/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002585/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2586/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Sylvestre Ledrubed28ac2012-07-23 08:59:39 +00002587/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the parameter index
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002588/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002589bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002590 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2591 unsigned *ArgPos) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002592 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002593 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2594 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2595 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2596 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2597 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2598 return false;
2599 }
2600 }
2601 return true;
2602 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002603
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002604 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2605 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2606 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2607 QualType ToType = (*O);
2608 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002609 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002610 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2611 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002612 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2613 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2614 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2615 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002616 continue;
2617 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002618 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2619 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002620 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002621 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002622 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2623 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2624 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002625 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002626 }
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002627 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002628 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002629 }
2630 }
2631 return true;
2632}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002633
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002634/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2635/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002636/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002637/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2638/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2639/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002640bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002641 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002642 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002643 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002644 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002645 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002646
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002647 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2648
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002649 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2650 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2651 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2652 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2653 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2654 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2655 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2656 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2657 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2658 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2659 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002660 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2661 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002662 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2663 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002664
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002665 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2666 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002667 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2668 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002669 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2670 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002671 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002672 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002673 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002674
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002675 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002676 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002677 }
2678 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002679 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2680 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2681 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2682 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002683 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2684 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2685 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002686 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002687 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002688 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2689 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2690 } else {
2691 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002692 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002693 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2694 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2695 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002696 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002697
2698 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2699 // reasons.
2700 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2701 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2702
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002703 return false;
2704}
2705
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002706/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2707/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2708/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2709/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2710/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2711bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002712 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002713 bool InOverloadResolution,
2714 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002715 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002716 if (!ToTypePtr)
2717 return false;
2718
2719 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002720 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2721 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2722 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002723 ConvertedType = ToType;
2724 return true;
2725 }
2726
2727 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002728 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002729 if (!FromTypePtr)
2730 return false;
2731
2732 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2733 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2734 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2735 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002736
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002737 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002738 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002739 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002740 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2741 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2742 return true;
2743 }
2744
2745 return false;
2746}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002747
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002748/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2749/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002750/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002751/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2752/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2753/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002754bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002755 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002756 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002757 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002758 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002759 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002760 if (!FromPtrType) {
2761 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002762 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002763 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002764 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002765 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002766 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002767 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002768
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002769 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002770 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2771 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002772
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002773 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2774 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002775
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002776 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2777 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2778 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002779
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002780 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002781 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002782 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2783 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2784 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2785 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002786
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002787 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2788 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002789 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2790 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2791 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2792 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002793 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002794
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002795 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002796 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2797 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2798 << From->getSourceRange();
2799 return true;
2800 }
2801
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002802 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002803 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2804 Paths.front(),
2805 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002806
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002807 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002808 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002809 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002810 return false;
2811}
2812
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002813/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2814/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2815/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002816///
2817/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2818/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2819/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002820bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002821Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002822 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002823 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2824 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002825 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2826
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002827 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2828 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002829 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002830 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002831
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002832 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2833 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2834 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2835 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002836 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002837 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002838 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2839 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2840 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002841 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002842 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2843 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002844 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002845
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002846 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2847 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2848
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002849 // Objective-C ARC:
2850 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2851 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2852 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2853 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2854 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2855 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2856 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2857 } else {
2858 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2859 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2860 return false;
2861 }
2862 }
2863
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002864 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2865 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2866 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2867 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2868 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2869 }
2870
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002871 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2872 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002873 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002874 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002875
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002876 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2877 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002878 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002879 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002880 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002881
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002882 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2883 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002884 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002885 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002886 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002887
2888 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2889 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2890 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2891 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2892 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002893 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002894}
2895
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002896/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2897/// atomic type.
2898///
2899/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2900/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002901static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2902 bool InOverloadResolution,
2903 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2904 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002905 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2906 if (!ToAtomic)
2907 return false;
2908
2909 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2910 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2911 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2912 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2913 return false;
2914
2915 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2916 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2917 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2918 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2919 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2920 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2921 return true;
2922}
2923
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002924static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2925 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2926 QualType Type) {
2927 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2928 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2929 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2930 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2931 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2932 return true;
2933 }
2934 return false;
2935}
2936
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002937static OverloadingResult
2938IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2939 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2940 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2941 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2942 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002943 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2944 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002945 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2946 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2947 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2948
2949 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2950 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2951 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2952 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2953 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2954 Constructor
2955 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2956 else
2957 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2958
2959 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2960 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2961 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2962 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002963 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2964 // suppress conversions.
2965 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2966 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002967 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2968 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2969 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002970 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002971 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002972 else
2973 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002974 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002975 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002976 }
2977 }
2978
2979 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2980
2981 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2982 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2983 case OR_Success: {
2984 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2985 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002986 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2987 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2988 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2989 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2990 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2991 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2992 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2993 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2994 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2995 return OR_Success;
2996 }
2997
2998 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2999 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3000 case OR_Deleted:
3001 return OR_Deleted;
3002 case OR_Ambiguous:
3003 return OR_Ambiguous;
3004 }
3005
3006 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3007}
3008
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003009/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3010/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3011/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3012/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3013/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3014/// false and User is unspecified.
3015///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003016/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3017/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3018/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003019static OverloadingResult
3020IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003021 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3022 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003023 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003024 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3025 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3026
3027 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3028 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003029 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003030 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3031 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3032 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3033 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3034 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3035 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3036 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3037 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003038 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003039 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003040 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003041 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3042
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003043 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003044 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3045 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3046 // to try to recover.
3047 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003048 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3049 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3050 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003051
3052 Expr **Args = &From;
3053 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3054 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003055 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003056 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
3057 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3058 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3059 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3060 return Result;
3061 // Never mind.
3062 CandidateSet.clear();
3063
3064 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3065 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003066 Args = InitList->getInits();
3067 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3068 ListInitializing = true;
3069 }
3070
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003071 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3072 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003073 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003074 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3075 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3076
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003077 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3078 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3079 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003080 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003081 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003082 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003083 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3084 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003085 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003086
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003087 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3088 if (ListInitializing)
3089 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3090 else
3091 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3092 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003093 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3094 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3095 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3096 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3097 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3098 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003099 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3100 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003101 }
3102 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003103 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003104 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3105 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003106 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003107 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003108 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003109 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3110 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003111 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003112 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003113 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003114 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003115 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003116 }
3117 }
3118
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003119 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003120 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003121 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003122 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003123 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003124 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003125 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003126 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3127 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003128 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3129 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3130 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3131 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3132 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003133 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3134 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003135 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3136 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3137 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3138
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003139 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3140 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003141 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3142 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003143 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003144 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003145
3146 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3147 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003148 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3149 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3150 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003151 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003152 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3153 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003154 }
3155 }
3156 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003157 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003158
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003159 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3160
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003161 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003162 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003163 case OR_Success:
3164 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3165 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3166 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3167 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3168 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3169 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3170 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3171 // the argument of the constructor.
3172 //
3173 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003174 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3175 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3176 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3177 } else {
3178 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3179 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3180 else {
3181 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3182 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3183 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003184 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003185 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003186 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003187 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003188 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3189 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3190 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3191 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003192 }
3193 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003194 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3195 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3196 //
3197 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3198 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3199 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3200 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3201 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003202 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003203 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003204 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003205 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003206
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003207 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3208 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3209 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3210 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3211 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3212 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3213 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3214 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3215 // 13.3.3.1).
3216 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3217 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003218 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003219 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003220
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003221 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3222 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3223 case OR_Deleted:
3224 // No conversion here! We're done.
3225 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003226
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003227 case OR_Ambiguous:
3228 return OR_Ambiguous;
3229 }
3230
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003231 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003232}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003233
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003234bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003235Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003236 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003237 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003238 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003239 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003240 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003241 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003242 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003243 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3244 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3245 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003246 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003247 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3248 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3249 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003250 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003251 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003252 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003253}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003254
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003255/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3256/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3257/// is possible.
3258static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3259compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3260 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3261 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003262 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003263 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3264
3265 // Objective-C++:
3266 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3267 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3268 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3269 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3270 // to keep code working.
3271 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3272 if (!Conv1)
3273 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3274
3275 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3276 if (!Conv2)
3277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3278
3279 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3280 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3281 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3282 if (Block1 != Block2)
3283 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3284 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3285 }
3286
3287 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3288}
3289
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003290/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3291/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3292/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003293static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3294CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3295 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3296 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003297{
3298 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3299 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3300 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3301 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3302 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3303 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3304 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3305 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003306 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003307 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3308 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3309 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3310 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3311 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003312 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3313 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003314 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003315 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003316
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003317 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3318 // the same kind.
3319 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3320 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3321
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003322 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3323 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3324
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003325 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3326 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3327 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003328 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003329 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3330 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003331 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003332 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3333 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3334 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3335 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3336 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3337 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003338 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003339 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003340 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3341 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3342 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003343 else
3344 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3345 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3346 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003347 }
3348
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003349 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3350 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3351 // for some X and L2 does not.
3352 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003353 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003354 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3355 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003356 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3357 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3358 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3359 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3360 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3361 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003362 }
3363
3364 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003365}
3366
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003367static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3368 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3369 Qualifiers Quals;
3370 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003371 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003372 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003373
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003374 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3375}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003376
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003377// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3378// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3379static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3380compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3381 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3382 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3383 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3384 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3385
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003386 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003387 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003388 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3389 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3390 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3391 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003392
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003393 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3394 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3395 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3396 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3397 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3398 else
3399 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003400 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003401 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3402
3403 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3404 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3405 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3406 }
3407
3408 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3409 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3410 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3411 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3412
3413 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3414 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3415 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3416 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003417
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003418 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3419}
3420
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003421/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3422/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3423static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3424 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3425 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3426 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3427 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003428 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003429 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003430 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003431 // reference*.
3432 //
3433 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3434 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3435 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3436 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3437 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003438 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3439 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3440 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003441
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003442 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3443 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3444 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3445 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3446}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003447
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003448/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3449/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3450/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003451static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3452CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3453 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3454 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003455{
3456 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3457 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3458
3459 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3460 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3461 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3462 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3463 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003464 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003465 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003466 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003467
3468 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3469 // defined below), or, if not that,
3470 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3471 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3472 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3473 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3474 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3475 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003476
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003477 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3478 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3479 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003480
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003481 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3482 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3483 // that is such a conversion.
3484 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3485 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3486 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3487 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3488
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003489 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3490 //
3491 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003492 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3493 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3494 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003495 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003496 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003497 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003498 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003499 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3500 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3501 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003502 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3503 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003504 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3505 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3506 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003507 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003508 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003509 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003510 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3511 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003512 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3513 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3514 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003515 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3516 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003517
3518 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3519 // conversion, if we need to.
3520 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003521 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003522 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003523 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003524
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003525 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3526 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003527
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003528 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003529 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003530 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003531 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3532
3533 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3534 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003535 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3536 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3537 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3538 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3539 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3540 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3541 FromObjCPtr2);
3542 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3543 FromObjCPtr1);
3544 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3545 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3546 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3547 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003548 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003549 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003550
3551 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3552 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003553 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003554 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003555 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003556
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003557 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003558 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3559 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3560 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3561 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3562 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003563
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003564 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3565 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3566 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3567 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3568 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3569 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003570 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3571 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003572 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3573 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003574 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003575 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3576 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003577 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003578 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3579 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3580 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3581 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3582 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3583 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3584 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3585 }
3586
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003587 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3588 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003589 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003590 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003591 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003592 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003593 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3594 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3595 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003597 }
3598 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003599
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003600 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3601 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3602 // is between types of the same size.
3603 // For example:
3604 // void f(float);
3605 // void f(int);
3606 // int main {
3607 // long a;
3608 // f(a);
3609 // }
3610 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3611 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003612 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003613 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3614 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3615 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3616 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3617 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3618
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003619 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3620}
3621
3622/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3623/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003624/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3625ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003626CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3627 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3628 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003629 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003630 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3631 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3632 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3633 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3634 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3635 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3636 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3637 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3638
3639 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3640 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003641 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3642 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003643 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3644 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003645 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003646 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3647 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003648
3649 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3650 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003651 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003652 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3653
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003654 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3655 // for comparison.
3656 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003657 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003658 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003659 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003660
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003661 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003662 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003663
3664 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3665 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3666 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3667 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3668 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3669 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3670 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3671 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3672 }
3673
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003674 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003675 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3676 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3677 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003678 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003679 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3680 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3681 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3682 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3683 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3684 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3685 // about how the sequences rank.
3686 ;
3687 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3688 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3689 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3690 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3691 // qualifiers.
3692 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003693
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003694 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3695 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3696 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3697 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3698 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3699 // qualifiers.
3700 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003701
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003702 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3703 } else {
3704 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3705 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3706 }
3707
3708 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003709 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003710 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003711 }
3712
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003713 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3714 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3715 switch (Result) {
3716 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003717 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003718 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3719 break;
3720
3721 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3722 break;
3723
3724 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003725 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003726 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3727 break;
3728 }
3729
3730 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003731}
3732
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003733/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3734/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003735/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3736/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3737/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003738ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003739CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3740 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3741 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003742 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003743 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003744 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003745 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003746
3747 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3748 // conversion, if we need to.
3749 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003750 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003751 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003752 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003753
3754 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003755 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3756 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3757 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3758 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003759
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003760 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003761 //
3762 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3763 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003764 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003765 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003766 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003767 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3768 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3769 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3770 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003771 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003772 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003773 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003774 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003775 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003776 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003777 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003778 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003779
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003780 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003781 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003782 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003783 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003784 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3786 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003787
3788 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3789 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003790 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003791 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003792 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003793 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003794 }
3795 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3796 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3797 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3798 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3799 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3800 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3801 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3802 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3803 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3804 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3805
3806 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3807 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3808 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3809 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3810 // Objective-C pointer types.
3811 bool FromAssignLeft
3812 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3813 bool FromAssignRight
3814 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3815 bool ToAssignLeft
3816 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3817 bool ToAssignRight
3818 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3819
3820 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3821 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3822 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3823 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3824 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3825 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3826 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3827 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3828
3829 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3830 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3831 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3832 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3833 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3834 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3835
3836 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3837 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3838 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3839 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3840 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3841 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3842 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3843 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3844
3845 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3846 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3847 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3848 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3849 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3850 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003851
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003852 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3853 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3854 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3855 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3856 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3857 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3858
3859 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3860 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3861 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3862 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3863 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003864 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003865 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003866
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003867 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003868 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3869 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3870 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003871 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003872 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003873 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003874 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003875 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003876 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003877 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003878 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3879 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3880 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3881 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3882 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3883 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3884 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3885 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3886 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003887 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003888 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003889 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003890 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003891 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003892 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3893 }
3894 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3895 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003896 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003897 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003898 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003899 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3900 }
3901 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003902
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003903 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003904 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003905 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3906 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3907 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003908 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3909 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3910 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003911 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003912 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003913 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3914 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003915
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003916 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003917 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3918 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3919 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003920 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3921 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3922 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003923 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003924 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003925 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3926 }
3927 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003928
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003929 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3930}
3931
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003932/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3933/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3934/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3935/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3936/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3937/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3938/// type being initialized.
3939Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3940Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3941 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003942 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003943 bool &ObjCConversion,
3944 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003945 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3946 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3947 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3948
3949 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3950 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3951 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3952 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3953 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3954
3955 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3956 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3957 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3958 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003959 DerivedToBase = false;
3960 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003961 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003962 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3963 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003964 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003965 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3966 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003967 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3968 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3969 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3970 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003971 else
3972 return Ref_Incompatible;
3973
3974 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3975 // least).
3976
3977 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3978 // for comparison.
3979 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3980 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3981 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3982 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3983
3984 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3985 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3986 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3987 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3988 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3989 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3990 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003991 //
3992 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3993 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3994 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3995 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003996 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3997 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3998 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3999 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4000 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4001 }
4002
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004003 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004004 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004005 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004006 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4007 else
4008 return Ref_Related;
4009}
4010
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004011/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004012/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4013static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004014FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4015 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4016 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4017 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004018 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4019 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4020 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4021
4022 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004023 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4024 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4025 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4026 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4027 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004028 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4029 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4030 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4031 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4032
4033 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4034 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4035 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4036 if (ConvTemplate)
4037 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4038 else
4039 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4040
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004041 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004042 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4043 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4044 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004045
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004046 if (AllowRvalues) {
4047 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4048 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004049 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004050
4051 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4052 // functions that return lvalues.
4053 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4054 const ReferenceType *RefType
4055 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4056 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4057 continue;
4058 }
4059
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004060 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004061 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4062 DeclLoc,
4063 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4064 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4065 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004066 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004067 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004068 continue;
4069 } else {
4070 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4071 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4072 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4073
4074 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4075 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4076 if (!RefType ||
4077 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4078 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4079 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004080 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004081
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004082 if (ConvTemplate)
4083 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004084 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004085 else
4086 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004087 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004088 }
4089
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004090 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4091
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004092 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004093 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004094 case OR_Success:
4095 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4096 //
4097 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4098 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4099 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4100 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4101 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4102 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4103 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4104 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4105 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4106 return false;
4107
4108 ICS.setUserDefined();
4109 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4110 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004111 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004112 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004113 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004114 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4115 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4116 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4117 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4118 return true;
4119
4120 case OR_Ambiguous:
4121 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4122 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4123 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4124 if (Cand->Viable)
4125 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4126 return true;
4127
4128 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4129 case OR_Deleted:
4130 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4131 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4132 return false;
4133 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004134
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004135 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004136}
4137
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004138/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4139/// initialization.
4140static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004141TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004142 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4143 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004144 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004145 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4146
4147 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4148 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4149 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4150
4151 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4152 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4153
4154 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4155 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4156 // type of the resulting function.
4157 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4158 DeclAccessPair Found;
4159 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4160 false, Found))
4161 T2 = Fn->getType();
4162 }
4163
4164 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4165 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4166 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004167 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004168 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004169 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004170 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004171 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004172 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004173
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004174
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004175 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004176 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4177 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4178
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004179 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004180 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004181 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4182 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4183 //
4184 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4185 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4186 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004187 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004188 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4189 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4190 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4191 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4192 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4193 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4194 ICS.setStandard();
4195 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004196 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4197 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4198 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004199 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4200 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4201 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4202 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4203 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4204 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4205 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004206 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4207 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4208 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004209 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004210 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004211 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004212
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004213 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4214 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4215 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4216 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004217 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004218 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004219
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004220 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4221 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4222 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4223 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4224 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4225 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4226 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4227 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004228 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004229 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004230 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4231 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4232 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004233 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004234 }
4235 }
4236
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4238 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004239 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004240 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004241 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4242 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4243 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4244 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4245 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4246 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4247 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004248 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4249 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004250 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004251 return ICS;
4252
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004253 // -- If the initializer expression
4254 //
4255 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004256 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004257 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4258 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4259 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4260 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4261 ICS.setStandard();
4262 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004263 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004264 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4265 : ICK_Identity;
4266 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4267 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4268 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4269 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4270 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4271 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4272 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4273 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4274 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4275 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4276 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004277 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004278 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004279 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004280 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4281 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004282 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004283 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004284 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004285 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004286 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004287 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004288
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004289 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4290 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004291 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4292 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004293 // "cv3 T3",
4294 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004295 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004296 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004297 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004298 // class subobject).
4299 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004300 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004301 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4302 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4303 AllowExplicit)) {
4304 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4305 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4306 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4307 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004308 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004309 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4310 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4311
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004312 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004313 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004314
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004315 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4316 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4317 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4318 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4319 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4320 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4321 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4322 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4323 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4324 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4325 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4326 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004327 //
4328 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4329 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4330 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4331 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4332 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4333 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4334 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4335 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4336 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4337 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004338 }
4339
4340 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4341 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4342 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4343 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4344 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4345 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4346 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4347 return ICS;
4348
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004349 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4350 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4351 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4352 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4353 return ICS;
4354
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004355 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004356 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4357 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4358 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4359 // underlying type of the reference according to
4360 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4361 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4362 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4363 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4364 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004365 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4366 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004367 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004368 /*CStyle=*/false,
4369 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004370
4371 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4372 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4373 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004374 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4375 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4376 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004377 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004378 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004379 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004380 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4381 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4382 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4383 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4384 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4385 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4386 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4387 DeclType);
4388 return ICS;
4389 }
4390 }
4391 }
4392
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004393 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004394 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4395 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4396 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4397 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4398 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004399 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004400
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004401 return ICS;
4402}
4403
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004404static ImplicitConversionSequence
4405TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4406 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4407 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004408 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4409 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004410
4411/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4412/// initializer list From.
4413static ImplicitConversionSequence
4414TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4415 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4416 bool InOverloadResolution,
4417 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4418 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4419 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4420 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4421
4422 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4423 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004424 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004425
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004426 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004427 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004428 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004429 return Result;
4430
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004431 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4432 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4433 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4434 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4435 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004436 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004437 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004438 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004439 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004440 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004441 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004442 if (!X.isNull()) {
4443 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4444 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4445 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4446 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4447 InOverloadResolution,
4448 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4449 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4450 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4451 Result = ICS;
4452 break;
4453 }
4454 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4455 if (Result.isBad() ||
4456 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4457 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4458 Result = ICS;
4459 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004460
4461 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4462 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4463 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4464 Result.setStandard();
4465 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4466 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4467 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4468 }
4469
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004470 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004471 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004472 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004473 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004474
4475 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4476 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4477 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4478 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4479 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4480 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004481 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4482 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4483 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4484 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4485 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4486 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4487 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004488 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004489 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004490
4491 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4492 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4493 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4494 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004495 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004496 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4497 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4498 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4499 InitializedEntity Entity =
4500 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4501 /*Consumed=*/false);
4502 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4503 Result.setUserDefined();
4504 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4505 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4506 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4507 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4508
4509 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4510 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4511 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004512 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004513 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004514 return Result;
4515 }
4516
4517 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4518 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004519 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4520 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4521 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4522 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4523
4524 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4525
4526 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4527 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4528 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4529 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4530
4531 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4532
4533 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4534 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4535 // type of the resulting function.
4536 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4537 DeclAccessPair Found;
4538 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4539 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4540 T2 = Fn->getType();
4541 }
4542
4543 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4544 bool dummy1 = false;
4545 bool dummy2 = false;
4546 bool dummy3 = false;
4547 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4548 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4549 dummy2, dummy3);
4550
4551 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4552 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4553 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4554 SuppressUserConversions,
4555 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4556 }
4557
4558 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4559 // initializer list.
4560 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4561 InOverloadResolution,
4562 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4563 if (Result.isFailure())
4564 return Result;
4565 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4566 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4567
4568 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4569 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4570 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4571 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4572 Result.UserDefined.After;
4573 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4574 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4575 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4576 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4577 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4578 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4579 } else
4580 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4581 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004582 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004583 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004584
4585 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4586 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4587 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4588 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4589 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4590 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004591 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4592 if (NumInits == 1)
4593 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4594 SuppressUserConversions,
4595 InOverloadResolution,
4596 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4597 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4598 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4599 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4600 Result.setStandard();
4601 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004602 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4603 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004604 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004605 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004606 return Result;
4607 }
4608
4609 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4610 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4611 return Result;
4612}
4613
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004614/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4615/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4616/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4617/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004618/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004619/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004620static ImplicitConversionSequence
4621TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004622 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004623 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004624 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4625 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004626 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4627 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4628 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4629
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004630 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004631 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004632 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4633 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004634 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004635
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004636 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4637 SuppressUserConversions,
4638 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004639 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004640 /*CStyle=*/false,
4641 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004642}
4643
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004644static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4645 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4646 Sema &S,
4647 SourceLocation Loc,
4648 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4649 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4650 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4651 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4652
4653 return !ICS.isBad();
4654}
4655
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004656/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4657/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4658/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004659static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004660TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004661 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004662 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4663 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4664 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004665 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4666 // const volatile object.
4667 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4668 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004669 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004670
4671 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4672 // to exit early.
4673 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004674
4675 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004676 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004677 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4678
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004679 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4680 // better have an lvalue.
4681 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4682 }
4683
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004684 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004685
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004686 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004687 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004688 // parameter is
4689 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004690 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4691 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4692 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004693 // ref-qualifier
4694 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004695 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004696 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4697 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004698 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004699 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004700 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4701 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4702 // non-constant references.
4703
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004704 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004705 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004706 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004707 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004708 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004709 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004710 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004711 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004712 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004713
4714 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4715 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004716 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004717 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4718 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4719 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004720 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004721 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004722 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004723 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4724 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004725 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004726 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004727
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004728 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4729 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4730 case RQ_None:
4731 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4732 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004733
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004734 case RQ_LValue:
4735 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4736 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004737 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004738 ImplicitParamType);
4739 return ICS;
4740 }
4741 break;
4742
4743 case RQ_RValue:
4744 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4745 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004746 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004747 ImplicitParamType);
4748 return ICS;
4749 }
4750 break;
4751 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004752
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004753 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004754 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004755 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4756 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004757 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004758 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004759 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4760 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004761 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004762 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004763 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4764 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4765 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004766 return ICS;
4767}
4768
4769/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4770/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4771/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004772ExprResult
4773Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004774 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004775 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004776 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004777 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004778 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004779 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004780
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004781 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004782 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004783 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4784 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004785 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004786 } else {
4787 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4788 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004789 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004790 }
4791
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004792 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4793 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004794 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004795 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4796 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004797 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4798 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4799 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4800 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4801 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4802 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004803 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004804 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4805 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4806 << From->getSourceRange();
4807 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4808 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004809 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004810 }
4811 }
4812
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004813 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004814 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004815 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004816 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004817
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004818 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4819 ExprResult FromRes =
4820 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4821 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4822 return ExprError();
4823 From = FromRes.take();
4824 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004825
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004826 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004827 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004828 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004829 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004830}
4831
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004832/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4833/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004834static ImplicitConversionSequence
4835TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004836 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004837 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004838 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4839 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004840 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004841 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004842 /*CStyle=*/false,
4843 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004844}
4845
4846/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4847/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004848ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004849 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4850 return ExprError();
4851
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004852 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004853 if (!ICS.isBad())
4854 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004855
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004856 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004857 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004858 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004859 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004860 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004861}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004862
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004863/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4864/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4865/// is acceptable.
4866static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4867 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4868 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4869 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4870 // conversions are fine.
4871 switch (SCS.Second) {
4872 case ICK_Identity:
4873 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4874 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004875 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004876 return true;
4877
4878 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004879 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4880 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4881 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4882 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4883 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4884
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004885 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4886 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4887 return false;
4888
4889 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4890 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4891 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4892 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4893 case ICK_Qualification:
4894 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4895 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4896 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4897 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4898 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4899 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4900 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4901 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4902 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4903 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4904 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4905 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4906 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4907 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4908
4909 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4910 break;
4911 }
4912
4913 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4914}
4915
4916/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4917/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4918/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4919ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4920 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4921 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004922 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004923 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4924
4925 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4926 return ExprError();
4927
4928 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4929 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4930 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4931 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4932 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4933 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4934 // narrowing conversions.
4935 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4936 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4937 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4938 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4939 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4940 /*CStyle=*/false,
4941 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4942 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4943 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4944 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4945 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004946 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004947 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4948 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4949 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4950 break;
4951 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4952 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4953 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4954 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004955 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004956 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4957 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4958 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4959 break;
4960 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4961 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4962 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004963 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004964 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4965 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4966 return ExprError();
4967
4968 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4969 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4970 }
4971
4972 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4973 if (Result.isInvalid())
4974 return Result;
4975
4976 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4977 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004978 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004979 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4980 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004981 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4982 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4983 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4984 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4985 break;
4986
4987 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004988 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4989 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4990 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004991 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004992 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004993 break;
4994
4995 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004996 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4997 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4998 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004999 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5000 break;
5001 }
5002
5003 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005004 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005005 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5006 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5007
5008 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
5009 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5010 // the AST.
5011 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005012 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005013 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005014
5015 if (Notes.empty()) {
5016 // It's a constant expression.
5017 return Result;
5018 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005019 }
5020
5021 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5022 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5023 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5024 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5025 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005026 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005027 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5028 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5029 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5030 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005031 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005032}
5033
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005034/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5035/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5036/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5037static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5038 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5039 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5040 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5041 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5042 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005043}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005044
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005045/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5046/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5047static ImplicitConversionSequence
5048TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5049 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5050 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5051 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5052 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5053 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5054 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5055 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5056 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5057 /*CStyle=*/false,
5058 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
5059
5060 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5061 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5062 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5063 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5064 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5065 break;
5066
5067 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5068 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5069 break;
5070
5071 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5072 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5073 break;
5074 }
5075
5076 return ICS;
5077}
5078
5079/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5080/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5081ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005082 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5083 return ExprError();
5084
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005085 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005086 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5087 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005088 if (!ICS.isBad())
5089 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005090 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005091}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005092
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005093/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5094/// type of a permitted flavor.
5095static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
5096 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5097 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5098}
5099
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005100/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005101/// enumeration type.
5102///
5103/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
5104/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
5105/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5106///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005107/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5108/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005109///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005110/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005111///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005112/// \param Diagnoser Used to output any diagnostics.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005113///
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005114/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
5115/// enumerations should be considered.
5116///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005117/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5118/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005119ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005120Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005121 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005122 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005123 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5124 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005125 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005126
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005127 // Process placeholders immediately.
5128 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5129 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5130 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
5131 From = result.take();
5132 }
5133
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005134 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
5135 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005136 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005137 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005138
5139 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5140
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005141 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005142 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
5143 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005144 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005145 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
5146 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005147 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005148 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005149
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005150 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005151 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005152 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser;
5153 Expr *From;
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005154
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005155 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From)
5156 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {}
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005157
5158 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005159 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005160 }
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005161 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005162
5163 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005164 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005165
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005166 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5167 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
5168 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005169 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
5170 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005171 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005172
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005173 bool HadMultipleCandidates
5174 = (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005175
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005176 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
5177 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005178 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005179 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
5180 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
5181 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
5182 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005183 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5184 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5185 else
5186 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5187 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005188 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005189 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005190
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005191 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5192 case 0:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005193 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005194 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5195 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5196 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005197
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005198 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5199 // conversion; use it.
5200 QualType ConvTy
5201 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5202 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor8987b232011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005203 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005204
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005205 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005206 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5207 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5208 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5209 ")");
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005210 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005211
5212 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005213 // explicit conversion function.
5214 if (isSFINAEContext())
5215 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005216
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005217 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005218 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5219 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005220 if (Result.isInvalid())
5221 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005222 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5223 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5224 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5225 Result.get(), 0,
5226 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005227 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005228
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005229 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5230 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005231
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005232 case 1: {
5233 // Apply this conversion.
5234 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5235 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005236
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005237 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5238 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5239 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005240 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005241 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) {
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005242 if (isSFINAEContext())
5243 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005244
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005245 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5246 << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005247 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005248
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005249 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5250 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005251 if (Result.isInvalid())
5252 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005253 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5254 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5255 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5256 Result.get(), 0,
5257 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005258 break;
5259 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005260
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005261 default:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005262 if (Diagnoser.Suppress)
5263 return ExprError();
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005264
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005265 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005266 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5267 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5268 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5269 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005270 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005271 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005272 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005273 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005274
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005275 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005276 !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
5277 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType())
5278 << From->getSourceRange();
5279 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005280
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005281 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005282}
5283
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005284/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005285/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5286/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5287/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005288///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005289/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005290/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5291/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292void
5293Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005294 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005295 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005296 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005297 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005298 bool PartialOverloading,
5299 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005300 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005301 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005302 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005303 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005304 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005305
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005306 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005307 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5308 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5309 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5310 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5311 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005312 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5313 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5314 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005315 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005316 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005317 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005318 return;
5319 }
5320 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5321 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005322 }
5323
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005324 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005325 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005326
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005327 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005328 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005329
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005330 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5331 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5332 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5333 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5334 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005335 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005336 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005337 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5338 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005339 return;
5340 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005341
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005342 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005343 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005344 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005345 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005346 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005347 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005348 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005349 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005350
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005351 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5352
5353 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5354 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5355 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005356 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005357 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005358 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005359 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005360 return;
5361 }
5362
5363 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5364 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5365 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5366 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5367 // exactly m parameters.
5368 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005369 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005370 // Not enough arguments.
5371 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005372 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005373 return;
5374 }
5375
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005376 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005377 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005378 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5379 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5380 Candidate.Viable = false;
5381 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5382 return;
5383 }
5384
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005385 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5386 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005387 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005388 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5389 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5390 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5391 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5392 // parameter of F.
5393 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005394 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005395 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005396 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005397 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5398 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005399 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005400 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005401 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5402 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005403 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005404 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005405 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005406 } else {
5407 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5408 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5409 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005410 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005411 }
5412 }
5413}
5414
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005415/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5416/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005417void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005418 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005419 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005420 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5421 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005422 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005423 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5424 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005425 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005426 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005427 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005428 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005429 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5430 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005431 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005432 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005433 SuppressUserConversions);
5434 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005435 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005436 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5437 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005438 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005439 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005440 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005441 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005442 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5443 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005444 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005445 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005446 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005447 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005448 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005449 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005450}
5451
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005452/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5453/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005454void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005455 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005456 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005457 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5458 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005459 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005460 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005461 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005462
5463 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5464 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005465
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005466 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5467 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5468 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005469 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5470 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005471 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5472 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005473 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005474 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005475 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005476 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5477 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005478 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005479 }
5480}
5481
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005482/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5483/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5484/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5485/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5486/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5487/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005488/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005490Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005491 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005492 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005493 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005494 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005495 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005497 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005498 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005499 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5500 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005501
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005502 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5503 return;
5504
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005505 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005506 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005507
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005508 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005509 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005510 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005511 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005512 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005513 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005514 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005515
5516 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5517
5518 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5519 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5520 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005521 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005522 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005523 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005524 return;
5525 }
5526
5527 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5528 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5529 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5530 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5531 // exactly m parameters.
5532 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005533 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005534 // Not enough arguments.
5535 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005536 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005537 return;
5538 }
5539
5540 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005541
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005542 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005543 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5544 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5545 else {
5546 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5547 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005548 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005549 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5550 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005551 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005552 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005553 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005554 return;
5555 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005556 }
5557
5558 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5559 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005560 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005561 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5562 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5563 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5564 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5565 // parameter of F.
5566 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005567 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005568 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005569 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005570 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5571 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005572 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005573 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005574 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005575 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005576 break;
5577 }
5578 } else {
5579 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5580 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5581 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005582 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005583 }
5584 }
5585}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005586
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005587/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5588/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5589/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005590void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005591Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005592 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005593 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005594 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005595 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005596 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005597 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005598 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005599 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005600 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5601 return;
5602
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005603 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005604 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005605 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005606 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005607 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5608 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5609 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5610 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5611 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005612 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005613 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5614 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005615 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5616 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005617 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005618 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5619 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5620 Candidate.Viable = false;
5621 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5622 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5623 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005624 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005625 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005626 Info);
5627 return;
5628 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005629
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005630 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5631 // deduction as a candidate.
5632 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005633 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005634 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005635 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005636 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5637 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005638}
5639
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005640/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5641/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5642/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005644Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005645 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005646 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005647 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005648 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005649 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005650 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5651 return;
5652
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005653 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005654 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005655 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005656 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005657 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5658 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5659 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5660 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5661 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005662 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005663 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5664 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005665 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5666 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005667 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005668 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005669 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5670 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005671 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005672 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5673 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005674 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005675 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005676 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005677 return;
5678 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005679
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005680 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5681 // deduction as a candidate.
5682 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005683 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005684 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005685}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005687/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005688/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005689/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005691/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5692/// conversion function produces).
5693void
5694Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005695 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005696 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005697 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5698 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005699 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5700 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005701 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005702 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5703 return;
5704
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005705 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005706 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005707
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005708 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005709 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005710 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005711 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005712 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005713 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005714 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005715 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005716 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005717 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005718 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005719
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005720 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005721 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5722 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005723 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005724 //
5725 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5726 // object parameter.
5727 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5728 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5729 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5730 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5731 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005732
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005733 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005734 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5735 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005736 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005737
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005738 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005739 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005740 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005741 return;
5742 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005743
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005744 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005745 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5746 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5747 QualType FromCanon
5748 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5749 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5750 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5751 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005752 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005753 return;
5754 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005755
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005756 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5757 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5758 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5759 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5760 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5761 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5762 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5763 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005764 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005765 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005766 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5767 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005768 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005769 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005770
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005771 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5772 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005773 Candidate.Viable = false;
5774 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5775 return;
5776 }
5777
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005778 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005779
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005780 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005781 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5782 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005783 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00005784 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, MultiExprArg(), CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005785 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005786 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005787 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005788 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005789 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5790 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005792 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005793 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5794 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005795
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005796 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5797 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005798 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005799 // shall have exact match rank.
5800 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5801 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5802 Candidate.Viable = false;
5803 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5804 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005805
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005806 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5807 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5808 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5809 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5810 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005811 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005812 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5813 Candidate.Viable = false;
5814 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5815 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005816 break;
5817
5818 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5819 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005820 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005821 break;
5822
5823 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005824 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005825 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5826 }
5827}
5828
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005829/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5830/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5831/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5832/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5833/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005834void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005835Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005836 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005837 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005838 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5839 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5840 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5841 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5842
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005843 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5844 return;
5845
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005846 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005847 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5848 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005849 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005850 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005851 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005852 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5853 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5854 Candidate.Viable = false;
5855 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5856 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5857 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005858 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005859 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005860 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005861 return;
5862 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005863
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005864 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5865 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5866 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005867 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005868 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005869}
5870
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005871/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5872/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5873/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5874/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5875/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5876void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005877 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005878 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005879 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005880 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005881 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005882 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005883 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5884 return;
5885
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005886 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005887 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005888
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005889 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005890 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005891 Candidate.Function = 0;
5892 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5893 Candidate.Viable = true;
5894 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005895 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005896 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005897
5898 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5899 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005900 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005901 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005902 Object->Classify(Context),
5903 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005904 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005905 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005906 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005907 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005908 return;
5909 }
5910
5911 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5912 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5913 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005914 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005915 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005916 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005917 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005918 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005919 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005920 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005921 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5922 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5923
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005925 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5926
5927 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5928 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5929 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005930 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005931 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005932 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005933 return;
5934 }
5935
5936 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5937 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005938 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005939 // Not enough arguments.
5940 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005941 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005942 return;
5943 }
5944
5945 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5946 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005947 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005948 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5949 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5950 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5951 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5952 // parameter of F.
5953 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005954 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005955 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005956 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005957 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5958 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005959 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005960 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005961 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005962 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005963 break;
5964 }
5965 } else {
5966 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5967 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5968 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005969 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005970 }
5971 }
5972}
5973
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005974/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5975/// member functions.
5976///
5977/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5978/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5979/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5980/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5981/// [over.match.oper]).
5982void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5983 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5984 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5985 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5986 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005987 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5988
5989 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5990 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5991 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5992 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5993 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5994 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5995 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5996 // constructed as follows:
5997 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005998
5999 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
6000 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
6001 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
6002 // empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006003 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006004 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00006005 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0))
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006006 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006007
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006008 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6009 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6010 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6011
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006012 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006013 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6014 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006015 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006016 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006017 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006018 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006019 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006020 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006021}
6022
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006023/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6024/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6025/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006026/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6027/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006028/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6029/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6030/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006031void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006032 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006033 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006034 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6035 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006036 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006037 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006038
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006039 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006040 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006041 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006042 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006043 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006044 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006045 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6046 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6047 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6048
6049 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6050 // arguments.
6051 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006052 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006053 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006054 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6055 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6056 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6057 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6058 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6059 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006060 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006061 //
6062 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6063 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6064 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6065 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006066 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006067 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006068 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006069 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6070 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006071 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006072 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006073 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006074 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006075 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6076 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006077 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006078 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006079 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006080 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006081 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006082 break;
6083 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006084 }
6085}
6086
6087/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6088/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6089/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6090/// enumeration types.
6091class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6092 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006093 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006094
6095 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6096 /// built-in candidates.
6097 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6098
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006099 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6100 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6101 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6102
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006103 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6104 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6105 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6106
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006107 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006108 /// candidates.
6109 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006110
6111 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6112 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6113
6114 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6115 /// were present in the candidate set.
6116 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6117
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006118 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6119 /// candidate set.
6120 bool HasNullPtrType;
6121
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006122 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6123 /// candidate type set.
6124 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006125
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006126 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6127 ASTContext &Context;
6128
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006129 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6130 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006131 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006132
6133public:
6134 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006135 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006136
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006137 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006138 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6139 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006140 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006141 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6142 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006143
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006144 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006145 SourceLocation Loc,
6146 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006147 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6148 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006149
6150 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6151 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6152
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006153 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006154 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6155
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006156 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6157 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6158
6159 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6160 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6161
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006162 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6163 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6164
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006165 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006166 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006167
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006168 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6169 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006170
6171 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6172 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006173 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006174};
6175
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006176/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006177/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6178/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6179/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6180/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6181/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6182/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006183///
6184/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006185bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006186BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6187 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006188
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006189 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006190 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006191 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006192
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006193 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006194 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006195 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006196 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006197 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6198 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6199 buildObjCPtr = true;
6200 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006201 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006202 }
6203
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006204 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6205 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6206 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6207 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6208 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6209 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006210
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006211 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006212 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6213 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006214
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006215 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6216 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6217 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006218 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006219 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006220
6221 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6222 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6223 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6224 (!hasRestrict ||
6225 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6226 continue;
6227
6228 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006229 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006230
6231 // Build qualified pointer type.
6232 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006233 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006234 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006235 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006236 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6237
6238 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6239 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006240 }
6241
6242 return true;
6243}
6244
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006245/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6246/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6247/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6248/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6249/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6250/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6251/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006252///
6253/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006254bool
6255BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6256 QualType Ty) {
6257 // Insert this type.
6258 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6259 return false;
6260
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006261 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6262 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006263
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006264 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006265 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6266 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6267 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6268 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6269 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6270 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006271 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6272
6273 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6274 // qualifiers.
6275 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6276 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6277 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006278
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006279 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006280 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6281 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006282 }
6283
6284 return true;
6285}
6286
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006287/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6288/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006289/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6290/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006291/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6292/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6293/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6294/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006295void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006296BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006297 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006298 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006299 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6300 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006301 // Only deal with canonical types.
6302 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6303
6304 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6305 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006306 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006307 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6308
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006309 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6310 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6311 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6312
6313 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006314 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006315
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006316 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6317 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6318 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6319
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006320 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6321 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6322 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6323
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006324 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6325 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6326 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006327 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6328 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006329 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006330 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006331 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6332 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6333 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6334 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006335 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006336 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006337 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006338 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006339 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6340 // extension.
6341 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006342 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006343 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6344 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006345 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6346 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6347 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6348 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006349
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006350 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006351 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6352 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6353 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6354 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6355 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006356 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6357 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6358 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006359
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006360 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6361 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6362 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6363 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006364
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006365 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6366 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6367 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6368 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006369 }
6370 }
6371 }
6372}
6373
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006374/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6375/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6376/// given type to the candidate set.
6377static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6378 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006379 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006380 unsigned NumArgs,
6381 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6382 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006383
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006384 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6385 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6386 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6387 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6388 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006389
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006390 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6391 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006392 ParamTypes[0]
6393 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006394 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6395 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006396 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006397 }
6398}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006399
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006400/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6401/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006402static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6403 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6404 const RecordType *TyRec;
6405 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6406 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006407 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006408 else
6409 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6410 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006411 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006412 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6413 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6414 return VRQuals;
6415 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006416
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006417 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006418 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6419 return VRQuals;
6420
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006421 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6422 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6423 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006424
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006425 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6426 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006427 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6428 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6429 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6430 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006431 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6432 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6433 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6434 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6435 // as see them.
6436 bool done = false;
6437 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006438 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6439 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006440 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6441 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006442 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006443 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6444 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6445 else
6446 done = true;
6447 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6448 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006449 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6450 return VRQuals;
6451 }
6452 }
6453 }
6454 return VRQuals;
6455}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006456
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006457namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006458
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006459/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6460/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6461/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6462/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6463class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006464 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6465 Sema &S;
6466 Expr **Args;
6467 unsigned NumArgs;
6468 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006469 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006470 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006471 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006472
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006473 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6474 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006475 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6476 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006477 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006478 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006479 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006480 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006481 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006482 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6483 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006484
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006485 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6486 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6487 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6488 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6489 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6490 // Start of promoted types.
6491 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6492 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6493 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006494
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006495 // Start of integral types.
6496 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6497 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6498 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006499 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006500 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6501 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6502 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006503 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006504 // End of promoted types.
6505
6506 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6507 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6508 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6509 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6510 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6511 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6512 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6513 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6514 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6515 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006516 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006517 };
6518 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6519 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006520
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006521 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6522 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6523 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6524 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6525 // The rules are basically:
6526 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6527 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6528 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6529 // - use the larger type
6530 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6531 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6532 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6533 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6534 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006535 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006536 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006537 Dep=-1,
6538 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006539 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006540 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006541 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006542/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6543/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6544/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6545/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6546/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6547/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6548/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6549/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6550/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6551/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6552/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006553 };
6554
6555 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6556 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6557 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6558
6559 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006560 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006561
6562 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6563 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006564 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6565 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006566 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6567 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6568
6569 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6570 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6571 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6572
6573 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6574 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6575 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6576 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6577 }
6578
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006579 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6580 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006581 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006582 bool HasVolatile,
6583 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006584 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6585 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6586 S.Context.IntTy
6587 };
6588
6589 // Non-volatile version.
6590 if (NumArgs == 1)
6591 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6592 else
6593 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6594
6595 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6596 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6597 if (HasVolatile) {
6598 ParamTypes[0] =
6599 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6600 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6601 if (NumArgs == 1)
6602 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6603 else
6604 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6605 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006606
6607 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6608 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6609 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6610 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6611 ParamTypes[0]
6612 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6613 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
6614 if (NumArgs == 1)
6615 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6616 else
6617 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6618
6619 if (HasVolatile) {
6620 ParamTypes[0]
6621 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6622 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6623 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6624 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
6625 if (NumArgs == 1)
6626 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1,
6627 CandidateSet);
6628 else
6629 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6630 }
6631 }
6632
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006633 }
6634
6635public:
6636 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6637 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6638 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006639 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006640 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006641 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6642 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6643 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006644 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6645 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006646 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6647 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6648 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006649 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006650 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006651 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006652 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006653 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006654 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6655 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006656 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006657 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006658 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006659 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6660 }
6661
6662 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6663 //
6664 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6665 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6666 // functions of the form
6667 //
6668 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6669 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6670 //
6671 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6672 //
6673 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6674 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6675 // candidate operator functions of the form
6676 //
6677 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6678 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6679 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006680 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6681 return;
6682
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006683 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6684 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6685 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006686 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006687 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6688 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006689 }
6690 }
6691
6692 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6693 //
6694 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6695 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6696 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6697 //
6698 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6699 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6700 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6701 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6702 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6703 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6704 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6705 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6706 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6707 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006708 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006709 continue;
6710
6711 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006712 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6713 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6714 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6715 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006716 }
6717 }
6718
6719 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6720 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6721 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6722 //
6723 // T& operator*(T*);
6724 //
6725 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006726 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006727 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006728 // T& operator*(T*);
6729 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6730 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6731 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6732 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6733 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6734 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6735 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006736 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6737 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006738
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006739 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6740 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6741 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006742
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006743 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6744 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6745 }
6746 }
6747
6748 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6749 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6750 // operator functions of the form
6751 //
6752 // T operator+(T);
6753 // T operator-(T);
6754 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006755 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6756 return;
6757
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006758 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6759 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006760 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006761 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6762 }
6763
6764 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6765 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6766 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6767 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6768 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6769 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6770 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6771 }
6772 }
6773
6774 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6775 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6776 // the form
6777 //
6778 // T* operator+(T*);
6779 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6780 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6781 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6782 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6783 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6784 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6785 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6786 }
6787 }
6788
6789 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6790 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6791 // operator functions of the form
6792 //
6793 // T operator~(T);
6794 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006795 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6796 return;
6797
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006798 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6799 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006800 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006801 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6802 }
6803
6804 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6805 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6806 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6807 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6808 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6809 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6810 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6811 }
6812 }
6813
6814 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6815 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6816 // functions of the form
6817 //
6818 // bool operator==(T,T);
6819 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6820 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6821 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6822 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6823
6824 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6825 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6826 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6827 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6828 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6829 ++MemPtr) {
6830 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6831 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6832 continue;
6833
6834 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6835 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6836 CandidateSet);
6837 }
6838 }
6839 }
6840
6841 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6842 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006843 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6844 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006845 //
6846 // bool operator<(T, T);
6847 // bool operator>(T, T);
6848 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6849 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6850 // bool operator==(T, T);
6851 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006852 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006853 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6854 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
6855 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
6856 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
6857 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006858 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006859 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
6860 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
6861 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
6862 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006863 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6864 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6865 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6866 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6867
6868 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6869 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6870 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6871 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6872 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6873 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6874 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6875 continue;
6876
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006877 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
6878 continue;
6879
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006880 QualType FirstParamType =
6881 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6882 QualType SecondParamType =
6883 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6884
6885 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6886 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6887 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6888 continue;
6889
6890 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6891 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6892 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6893 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6894 }
6895 }
6896 }
6897
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006898 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6899 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6900
6901 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6902 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6903 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6904 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6905 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6906 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6907 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6908 continue;
6909
6910 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6911 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6912 CandidateSet);
6913 }
6914 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6915 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6916 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6917 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6918 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6919
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006920 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6921 // candidate exists.
6922 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6923 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6924 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006925 continue;
6926
6927 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006928 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6929 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006930 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006931
6932 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6933 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6934 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6935 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6936 NullPtrTy))) {
6937 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6938 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6939 CandidateSet);
6940 }
6941 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006942 }
6943 }
6944
6945 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6946 //
6947 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6948 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6949 //
6950 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6951 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6952 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6953 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6954 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6955 //
6956 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6957 //
6958 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6959 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6960 //
6961 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6962 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6963 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6964 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6965
6966 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6967 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6968 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6969 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6970 };
6971 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6972 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6973 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6974 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006975 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6976 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6977 continue;
6978
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006979 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6980 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6981 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6982 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6983 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6984 CandidateSet);
6985 }
6986 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6987 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6988 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6989 continue;
6990
6991 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6992 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6993 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6994 }
6995 }
6996 }
6997 }
6998
6999 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7000 //
7001 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7002 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7003 //
7004 // LR operator*(L, R);
7005 // LR operator/(L, R);
7006 // LR operator+(L, R);
7007 // LR operator-(L, R);
7008 // bool operator<(L, R);
7009 // bool operator>(L, R);
7010 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7011 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7012 // bool operator==(L, R);
7013 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7014 //
7015 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7016 // between types L and R.
7017 //
7018 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7019 //
7020 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7021 // candidate operator functions of the form
7022 //
7023 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7024 //
7025 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7026 // between types L and R.
7027 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7028 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007029 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7030 return;
7031
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007032 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7033 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7034 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7035 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007036 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7037 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007038 QualType Result =
7039 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007040 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007041 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7042 }
7043 }
7044
7045 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7046 // conditional operator for vector types.
7047 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7048 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7049 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7050 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7051 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7052 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7053 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7054 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7055 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7056 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7057 if (!isComparison) {
7058 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7059 Result = *Vec1;
7060 else
7061 Result = *Vec2;
7062 }
7063
7064 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7065 }
7066 }
7067 }
7068
7069 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7070 //
7071 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7072 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7073 //
7074 // LR operator%(L, R);
7075 // LR operator&(L, R);
7076 // LR operator^(L, R);
7077 // LR operator|(L, R);
7078 // L operator<<(L, R);
7079 // L operator>>(L, R);
7080 //
7081 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7082 // between types L and R.
7083 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007084 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7085 return;
7086
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007087 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7088 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7089 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7090 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007091 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7092 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007093 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7094 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007095 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007096 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7097 }
7098 }
7099 }
7100
7101 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7102 //
7103 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7104 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7105 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7106 //
7107 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7108 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7109 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7110 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7111
7112 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7113 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7114 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7115 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7116 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7117 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7118 continue;
7119
7120 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
7121 CandidateSet);
7122 }
7123
7124 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7125 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7126 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7127 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7128 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7129 continue;
7130
7131 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
7132 CandidateSet);
7133 }
7134 }
7135 }
7136
7137 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7138 //
7139 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7140 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7141 // of the form
7142 //
7143 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7144 //
7145 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7146 //
7147 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7148 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7149 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7150 //
7151 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7152 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7153 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7154 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7155 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7156
7157 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7158 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7159 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7160 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7161 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7162 if (isEqualOp)
7163 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007164 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7165 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007166
7167 // non-volatile version
7168 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7169 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7170 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7171 };
7172 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7173 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7174
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007175 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7176 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7177 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007178 // volatile version
7179 ParamTypes[0] =
7180 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7181 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7182 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7183 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007184
7185 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7186 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7187 // restrict version
7188 ParamTypes[0]
7189 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7190 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7191 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7192
7193 if (NeedVolatile) {
7194 // volatile restrict version
7195 ParamTypes[0]
7196 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7197 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7198 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7199 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7200 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7201 CandidateSet,
7202 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7203 }
7204 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007205 }
7206
7207 if (isEqualOp) {
7208 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7209 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7210 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7211 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7212 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7213 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7214 continue;
7215
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007216 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7217 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7218 *Ptr,
7219 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007220
7221 // non-volatile version
7222 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7223 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7224
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007225 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7226 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7227 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007228 // volatile version
7229 ParamTypes[0] =
7230 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007231 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7232 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007233 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007234
7235 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7236 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7237 // restrict version
7238 ParamTypes[0]
7239 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7240 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7241 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7242
7243 if (NeedVolatile) {
7244 // volatile restrict version
7245 ParamTypes[0]
7246 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7247 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7248 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7249 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7250 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7251 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7252
7253 }
7254 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007255 }
7256 }
7257 }
7258
7259 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7260 //
7261 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7262 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7263 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7264 // the form
7265 //
7266 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7267 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7268 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7269 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7270 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7271 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007272 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7273 return;
7274
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007275 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7276 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7277 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7278 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007279 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007280
7281 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7282 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007283 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007284 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7285 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7286
7287 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7288 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7289 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007290 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007291 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007292 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7293 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007294 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7295 }
7296 }
7297 }
7298
7299 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7300 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7301 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7302 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7303 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7304 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7305 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7306 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7307 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7308 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7309 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7310 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7311 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7312 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7313 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7314
7315 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7316 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7317 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7318 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007319 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7320 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007321 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7322 }
7323 }
7324 }
7325 }
7326
7327 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7328 //
7329 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7330 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7331 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7332 //
7333 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7334 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7335 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7336 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7337 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7338 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7339 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007340 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7341 return;
7342
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007343 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7344 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7345 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7346 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007347 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007348
7349 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7350 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007351 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007352 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7353 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7354 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007355 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007356 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7357 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7358 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7359 CandidateSet);
7360 }
7361 }
7362 }
7363 }
7364
7365 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7366 //
7367 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7368 //
7369 // bool operator!(bool);
7370 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7371 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7372 void addExclaimOverload() {
7373 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7374 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7375 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7376 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7377 }
7378 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7379 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7380 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7381 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7382 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7383 }
7384
7385 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7386 //
7387 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7388 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7389 //
7390 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7391 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7392 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7393 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7394 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7395 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7396 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7397 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7398 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7399 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7400 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7401 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007402 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7403 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007404
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007405 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7406
7407 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7408 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7409 }
7410
7411 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7412 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7413 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7414 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7415 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7416 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007417 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7418 continue;
7419
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007420 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7421
7422 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7423 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7424 }
7425 }
7426
7427 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7428 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7429 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7430 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7431 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7432 //
7433 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7434 //
7435 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7436 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7437 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7438 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7439 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7440 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7441 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7442 QualType C1;
7443 QualifierCollector Q1;
7444 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7445 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7446 continue;
7447 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7448 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7449 // volatile/restrict type.
7450 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7451 continue;
7452 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7453 continue;
7454 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7455 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7456 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7457 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7458 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7459 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7460 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7461 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7462 break;
7463 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7464 // build CV12 T&
7465 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7466 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7467 T.isVolatileQualified())
7468 continue;
7469 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7470 T.isRestrictQualified())
7471 continue;
7472 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7473 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7474 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7475 }
7476 }
7477 }
7478
7479 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7480 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7481 // therefore added as binary.
7482 //
7483 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7484 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7485 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7486 //
7487 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7488 //
7489 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7490 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7491 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7492
7493 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7494 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7495 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7496 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7497 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7498 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7499 continue;
7500
7501 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7502 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7503 }
7504
7505 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7506 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7507 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7508 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7509 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7510 continue;
7511
7512 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7513 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7514 }
7515
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007516 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007517 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7518 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7519 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7520 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7521 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7522 continue;
7523
7524 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7525 continue;
7526
7527 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7528 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7529 }
7530 }
7531 }
7532 }
7533};
7534
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007535} // end anonymous namespace
7536
7537/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7538/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7539/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7540/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7541/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7542void
7543Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7544 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7545 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7546 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007547 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7548 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007549 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7550 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007551 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7552 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007553 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7554 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007555
7556 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7557 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007558 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007559 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7560 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7561 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7562 OpLoc,
7563 true,
7564 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7565 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7566 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7567 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007568 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7569 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7570 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7571 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7572 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007573 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007574
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007575 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7576 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007577 //
7578 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7579 // 'bool' overloads.
7580 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7581 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007582 return;
7583
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007584 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7585 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7586 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007587 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007588 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7589
7590 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007591 switch (Op) {
7592 case OO_None:
7593 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007594 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007595
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007596 case OO_New:
7597 case OO_Delete:
7598 case OO_Array_New:
7599 case OO_Array_Delete:
7600 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007601 llvm_unreachable(
7602 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007603
7604 case OO_Comma:
7605 case OO_Arrow:
7606 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7607 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7608 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007609 break;
7610
7611 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007612 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007613 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007614 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007615
7616 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007617 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007618 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007619 } else {
7620 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7621 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7622 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007623 break;
7624
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007625 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007626 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007627 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7628 else
7629 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7630 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007631
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007632 case OO_Slash:
7633 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007634 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007635
7636 case OO_PlusPlus:
7637 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007638 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7639 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007640 break;
7641
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007642 case OO_EqualEqual:
7643 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007644 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007645 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007646
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007647 case OO_Less:
7648 case OO_Greater:
7649 case OO_LessEqual:
7650 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007651 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007652 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7653 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007654
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007655 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007656 case OO_Caret:
7657 case OO_Pipe:
7658 case OO_LessLess:
7659 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007660 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007661 break;
7662
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007663 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7664 if (NumArgs == 1)
7665 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7666 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7667 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7668 break;
7669
7670 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7671 break;
7672
7673 case OO_Tilde:
7674 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7675 break;
7676
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007677 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007678 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007679 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007680
7681 case OO_PlusEqual:
7682 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007683 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007684 // Fall through.
7685
7686 case OO_StarEqual:
7687 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007688 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007689 break;
7690
7691 case OO_PercentEqual:
7692 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7693 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7694 case OO_AmpEqual:
7695 case OO_CaretEqual:
7696 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007697 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007698 break;
7699
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007700 case OO_Exclaim:
7701 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007702 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007703
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007704 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007705 case OO_PipePipe:
7706 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007707 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007708
7709 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007710 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007711 break;
7712
7713 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007714 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007715 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007716
7717 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007718 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007719 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7720 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007721 }
7722}
7723
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007724/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7725/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7726///
7727/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7728/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7729/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7730/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007731void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007732Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007733 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007734 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007735 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007736 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007737 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007738 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007739
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007740 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7741 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7742 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7743 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7744 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7745 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7746
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007747 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007748 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007749
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007750 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007751 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7752 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7753 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007754 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007755 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007756 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007757 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007758 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007759
7760 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7761 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007762 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007763 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007764 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007765 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007766 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007767
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007768 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7769 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007770 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007771 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007772 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007773 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007774 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007775}
7776
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007777/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7778/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007779bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007780isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007781 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7782 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007783 SourceLocation Loc,
7784 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007785 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7786 // functions.
7787 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7788 return Cand1.Viable;
7789 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7790 return false;
7791
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007792 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7793 //
7794 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7795 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7796 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7797 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7798 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7799 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7800 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007801
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007802 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007803 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7804 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007805 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007806 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7807 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007808 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007809 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007810 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7811 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007812 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7813 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7814 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7815 HasBetterConversion = true;
7816 break;
7817
7818 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7819 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7820 return false;
7821
7822 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7823 // Do nothing.
7824 break;
7825 }
7826 }
7827
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007828 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007829 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007830 if (HasBetterConversion)
7831 return true;
7832
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007833 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007834 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007835 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007836 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7837 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007838
7839 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7840 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7841 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007842 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007843 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007844 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007845 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007846 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7847 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7848 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007849 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007850 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007851 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007852 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007853 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007854
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007855 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7856 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7857 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7858 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7859 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7860 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007861 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007862 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007863 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007864 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7865 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7866 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7867 // pointer or block.
7868 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7869 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7870 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7871 return FuncResult;
7872
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007873 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7874 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007875 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7876 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7877 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7878 return true;
7879
7880 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7881 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7882 return false;
7883
7884 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7885 // Do nothing
7886 break;
7887 }
7888 }
7889
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007890 return false;
7891}
7892
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007893/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007894/// within an overload candidate set.
7895///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007896/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007897/// which overload resolution occurs.
7898///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007899/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
7900/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007901///
7902/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007903OverloadingResult
7904OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007905 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007906 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007907 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007908 Best = end();
7909 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7910 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007911 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007912 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007913 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007914 }
7915
7916 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007917 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007918 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7919
7920 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7921 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007922 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007923 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007924 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007925 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007926 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007927 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007928 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007929 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007930 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007931
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007932 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007933 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007934 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7935 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007936 return OR_Deleted;
7937
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007938 return OR_Success;
7939}
7940
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007941namespace {
7942
7943enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7944 oc_function,
7945 oc_method,
7946 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007947 oc_function_template,
7948 oc_method_template,
7949 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007950 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7951 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007952 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007953 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007954 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007955 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007956};
7957
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007958OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7959 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7960 std::string &Description) {
7961 bool isTemplate = false;
7962
7963 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7964 isTemplate = true;
7965 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7966 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7967 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007968
7969 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007970 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007971 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007972
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007973 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7974 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7975
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007976 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7977 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7978
7979 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7980 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7981
7982 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7983 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7984 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007985 }
7986
7987 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7988 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7989 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007990 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007991 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007992
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007993 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7994 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7995
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00007996 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
7997 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7998
7999 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8000 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008001 }
8002
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008003 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008004}
8005
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008006void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
8007 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8008 if (!Ctor) return;
8009
8010 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8011 if (!Ctor) return;
8012
8013 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8014}
8015
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008016} // end anonymous namespace
8017
8018// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008019void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008020 std::string FnDesc;
8021 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008022 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8023 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8024 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8025 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008026 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008027}
8028
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008029//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8030// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008031void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008032 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8033
8034 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8035 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8036
8037 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8038 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8039 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8040 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8041 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008042 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008043 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8044 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008045 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008046 }
8047 }
8048}
8049
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008050/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8051/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8052/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008053void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8054 Sema &S,
8055 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8056 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8057 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8058 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008059 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8060 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8061 // refactoring here.
8062 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8063 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8064 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8065 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8066 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8067 break;
8068 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008069 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008070 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008071 if (I != E)
8072 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008073}
8074
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008075namespace {
8076
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008077void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8078 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8079 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008080 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8081 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8082
8083 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8084 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8085 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008086 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008087 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008088 if (I == 0)
8089 isObjectArgument = true;
8090 else
8091 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008092 }
8093
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008094 std::string FnDesc;
8095 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8096
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008097 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8098 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8099 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008100
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008101 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008102 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008103 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8104 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8105 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008106 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008107
8108 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8109 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8110 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8111 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008112 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008113 return;
8114 }
8115
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008116 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8117 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008118 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8119 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8120 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8121 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8122 else {
8123 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8124 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8125 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8126 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8127 }
8128
8129 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8130 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008131 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8132 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8133
8134 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8135 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8136 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8137 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8138 << FromTy
8139 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8140 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008141 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008142 return;
8143 }
8144
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008145 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008146 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008147 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8148 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8149 << FromTy
8150 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8151 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8152 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8153 return;
8154 }
8155
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008156 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8157 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8158 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8159 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8160 << FromTy
8161 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8162 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8163 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8164 return;
8165 }
8166
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008167 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8168 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8169
8170 if (isObjectArgument) {
8171 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8172 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8173 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8174 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8175 } else {
8176 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8177 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8178 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8179 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8180 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008181 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008182 return;
8183 }
8184
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008185 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8186 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8187 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8188 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8189 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8190 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8191 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8192 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8193 return;
8194 }
8195
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008196 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8197 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8198 // the failure.
8199 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8200 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8201 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8202 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8203 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8204 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8205 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8206 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008207 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008208 return;
8209 }
8210
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008211 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008212 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008213 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8214 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8215 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8216 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8217 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8218 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008219 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008220 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008221 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008222 }
8223 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8224 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8225 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8226 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8227 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8228 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8229 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8230 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8231 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008232 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8233 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008234 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8235 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8236 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8237 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8238 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8239 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8240 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8241 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008242 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8243 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8244 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8245 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8246 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8247 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008248 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008249 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008250
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008251 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008252 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008253 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008254 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8255 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008256 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008257 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008258 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008259 return;
8260 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008261
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008262 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8263 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8264 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8265 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8266 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8267 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8268 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8269 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8270 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8271 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8272 return;
8273 }
8274 }
8275
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008276 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8277 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8278 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008279 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008280 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8281 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8282
8283 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008284 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8285 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008286 FDiag << *HI;
8287 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8288
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008289 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008290}
8291
8292void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8293 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8294 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8295
8296 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8297 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8298
8299 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008300
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008301 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8302 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8303 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8304 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8305 // Just don't report anything.
8306 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8307 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8308 return;
8309
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008310 // at least / at most / exactly
8311 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8312 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008313 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8314 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8315 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008316 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008317 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008318 mode = 0; // "at least"
8319 else
8320 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8321 modeCount = MinParams;
8322 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008323 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8324 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8325 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008326 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8327 mode = 1; // "at most"
8328 else
8329 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8330 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8331 }
8332
8333 std::string Description;
8334 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8335
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008336 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8337 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8338 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8339 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8340 else
8341 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8342 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8343 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008344 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008345}
8346
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008347/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8348void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008349 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008350 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8351
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008352 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008353 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8354 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8355 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8356 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008357 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8358 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8359 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8360
8361 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008362 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8363 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8364 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008365 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008366 return;
8367 }
8368
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008369 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8370 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8371 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8372
8373 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8374
8375 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8376 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008377 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008378 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008379 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008380 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8381
8382 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8383 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8384 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8385 // done on dependent types).
8386 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8387
8388 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8389 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008390 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008391 return;
8392 }
8393
8394 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008395 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008396 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008397 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008398 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008399 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008400 which = 1;
8401 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008402 which = 2;
8403 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008404
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008405 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008406 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008407 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8408 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008409 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008410 return;
8411 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008412
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008413 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008414 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008415 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008416 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008417 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8418 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8419 else {
8420 int index = 0;
8421 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8422 index = TTP->getIndex();
8423 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8424 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8425 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8426 else
8427 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008428 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008429 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8430 << (index + 1);
8431 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008432 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008433 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008434
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008435 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8436 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8437 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8438 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008439
8440 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8441 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008442 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008443 return;
8444
8445 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008446 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008447 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008448 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8449 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8450 TemplateArgString = " ";
8451 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8452 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8453 }
8454
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008455 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8456 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8457 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8458 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8459 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8460 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8461 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8462 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8463 return;
8464 }
8465
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008466 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8467 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8468 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008469 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008470 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008471 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008472 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8473 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8474 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8475 }
8476
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008477 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008478 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008479 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008480 return;
8481 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008482
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008483 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8484 OverloadExpr::FindResult R =
8485 OverloadExpr::find(Cand->DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8486 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8487 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8488 << R.Expression->getName();
8489 return;
8490 }
8491
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008492 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8493 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
8494 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
8495 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8496 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8497 return;
8498
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008499 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8500 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008501 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008502 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008503 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008504 return;
8505 }
8506}
8507
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008508/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8509void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8510 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8511 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8512
8513 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8514 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8515
8516 std::string FnDesc;
8517 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8518
8519 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8520 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8521}
8522
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008523/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8524/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8525///
8526/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8527/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8528/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8529/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8530/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8531/// overload.
8532///
8533/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8534/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8535/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008536void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008537 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008538 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8539
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008540 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008541 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8542 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008543 std::string FnDesc;
8544 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008545
8546 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008547 << FnKind << FnDesc
8548 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008549 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008550 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008551 }
8552
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008553 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8554 if (Cand->Viable) {
8555 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8556 return;
8557 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008558
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008559 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8560 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8561 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8562 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008563
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008564 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008565 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008566
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008567 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8568 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008569 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008570 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008571
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008572 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8573 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008574 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008575 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8576 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008577
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008578 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8579 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8580 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8581 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008582 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008583
8584 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8585 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008586 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008587}
8588
8589void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8590 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8591 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8592 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8593 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8594 bool isLValueReference = false;
8595 bool isRValueReference = false;
8596 bool isPointer = false;
8597 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8598 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8599 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8600 isLValueReference = true;
8601 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8602 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8603 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8604 isRValueReference = true;
8605 }
8606 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8607 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8608 isPointer = true;
8609 }
8610 // Desugar down to a function type.
8611 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8612 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8613 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8614 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8615 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8616
8617 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8618 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008619 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008620}
8621
8622void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008623 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008624 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8625 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008626 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008627 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8628 TypeStr += Opc;
8629 TypeStr += "(";
8630 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008631 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008632 TypeStr += ")";
8633 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8634 } else {
8635 TypeStr += ", ";
8636 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8637 TypeStr += ")";
8638 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8639 }
8640}
8641
8642void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8643 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008644 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008645 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8646 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008647 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8648 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8649
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008650 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008651 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008652 }
8653}
8654
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008655SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8656 if (Cand->Function)
8657 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008658 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008659 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8660 return SourceLocation();
8661}
8662
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008663static unsigned
8664RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008665 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008666 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008667 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008668
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008669 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008670 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8671 return 1;
8672
8673 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8674 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8675 return 2;
8676
8677 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8678 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008679 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008680 return 3;
8681
8682 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8683 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8684 return 4;
8685
8686 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8687 return 5;
8688
8689 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8690 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8691 return 6;
8692 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008693 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008694}
8695
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008696struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8697 Sema &S;
8698 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008699
8700 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8701 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008702 // Fast-path this check.
8703 if (L == R) return false;
8704
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008705 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008706 if (L->Viable) {
8707 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8708
8709 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8710 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8711 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008712 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8713 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008714 } else if (R->Viable)
8715 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008716
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008717 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008718
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008719 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8720 if (!L->Viable) {
8721 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8722 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8723 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8724 return false;
8725 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8726 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8727 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008728
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008729 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8730 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8731 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8732 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8733 return true;
8734
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008735 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8736 // comes first.
8737 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8738 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8739 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8740 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008741 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008742 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8743 return true;
8744 else
8745 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008746 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008747
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008748 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8749 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008750 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008751
8752 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008753 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008754 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008755 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8756 L->Conversions[I],
8757 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008758 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8759 leftBetter++;
8760 break;
8761
8762 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8763 leftBetter--;
8764 break;
8765
8766 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8767 break;
8768 }
8769 }
8770 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8771 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8772
8773 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8774 return false;
8775
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008776 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8777 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8778 return true;
8779
8780 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8781 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008782 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008783 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8784 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008785
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008786 // TODO: others?
8787 }
8788
8789 // Sort everything else by location.
8790 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8791 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8792
8793 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8794 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8795 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8796
8797 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008798 }
8799};
8800
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008801/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008802/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008803void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008804 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008805 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8806
8807 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8808 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8809
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008810 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8811 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008812 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8813 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008814
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008815 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008816 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008817 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008818 while (true) {
8819 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8820 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008821 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008822 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008823 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008824 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008825 }
8826
8827 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8828 return;
8829
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008830 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8831 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8832
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008833 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008834 // operation somehow.
8835 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008836
8837 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8838 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8839
8840 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8841 QualType ConvType
8842 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8843 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8844 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8845 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8846 ArgIdx--;
8847 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8848 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8849 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8850 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8851 ArgIdx--;
8852 } else {
8853 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8854 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8855 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8856 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008857 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8858 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008859 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008860 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8861 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008862 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008863 return;
8864 }
8865
8866 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8867 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8868 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008869 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008870 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008871 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008872 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008873 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8874 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008875 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008876 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8877 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008878 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008879 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008880 else
8881 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8882 }
8883}
8884
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008885} // end anonymous namespace
8886
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008887/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8888/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008889/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008890void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8891 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008892 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008893 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008894 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008895 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8896 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008897 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008898 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8899 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008900 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008901 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008902 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008903 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008904 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8905 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8906 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8907 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008908 }
8909 }
8910
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008911 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008912 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008913
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008914 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008915
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008916 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008917 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008918 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008919 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8920 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008921
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008922 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8923 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8924 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008925 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008926 break;
8927 }
8928 ++CandsShown;
8929
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008930 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008931 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008932 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008933 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008934 else {
8935 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8936 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008937 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8938 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8939 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8940 //
8941 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8942 // different ambiguities, though.
8943 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008944 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008945 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8946 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008947
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008948 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008949 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008950 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008951 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008952
8953 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008954 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008955}
8956
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008957// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8958// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8959// R (A) --> R(A)
8960// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8961// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8962// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8963QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8964 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8965 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8966 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8967 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8968 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8969 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8970 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008971 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008972 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8973 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8974 Ret =
8975 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8976 return Ret;
8977}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008978
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008979// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8980// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8981class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8982{
8983 Sema& S;
8984 Expr* SourceExpr;
8985 const QualType& TargetType;
8986 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8987
8988 bool Complain;
8989 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8990 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008991
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008992 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8993 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008994
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008995 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8996 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8997 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008998 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008999
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009000public:
9001 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
9002 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
9003 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9004 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9005 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9006 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9007 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9008 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9009 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
9010 {
9011 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9012
9013 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9014 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9015 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009016 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009017 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009018
9019 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9020 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9021 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
9022 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
9023 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9024 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9025
9026 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9027 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9028 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9029 return;
9030 }
9031 }
9032
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009033 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
9034 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009035 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009036 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009037 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009038
9039 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9040 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009041
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009042 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9043 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9044 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9045 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9046 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9047 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9048 else
9049 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9050 }
9051 }
9052 }
9053
9054private:
9055 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9056 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9057 }
9058
9059 // [ToType] [Return]
9060
9061 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9062 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9063 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9064 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9065 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9066 }
9067
9068 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9069 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9070 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9071 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9072 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9073 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9074 // static when converting to member pointer.
9075 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9076 return false;
9077 }
9078 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9079 return false;
9080
9081 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9082 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9083 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9084 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9085 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9086 // overloaded functions considered.
9087 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009088 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009089 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9090 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9091 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9092 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
9093 Info)) {
9094 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9095 (void)Result;
9096 return false;
9097 }
9098
9099 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
9100 // This function template specicalization works.
9101 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
9102 assert(TargetFunctionType
9103 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
9104 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9105 return true;
9106 }
9107
9108 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9109 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009110 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009111 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9112 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009113 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9114 return false;
9115 }
9116 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9117 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009118
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009119 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009120 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009121 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9122 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9123 return false;
9124
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009125 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009126 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9127 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009128 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9129 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009130 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9131 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009132 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009133 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009134 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009135 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009136
9137 return false;
9138 }
9139
9140 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9141 bool Ret = false;
9142
9143 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9144 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9145 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9146 return false;
9147
9148 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9149 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9150 I != E; ++I) {
9151 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9152 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9153
9154 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9155 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9156 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9157 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9158 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9159 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9160 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9161 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9162 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9163 Ret = true;
9164 }
9165 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9166 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9167 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9168 Ret = true;
9169 }
9170 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9171 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009172 }
9173
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009174 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009175 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9176 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9177 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9178 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9179 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9180
9181 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9182 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9183 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9184 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009185
9186 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9187 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9188 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009189
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009190 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009191 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9192 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9193 S.PDiag(),
9194 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9195 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9196 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9197 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009198 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009199
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009200 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9201 // Make it the first and only element
9202 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9203 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9204 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009205 }
9206 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009207
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009208 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9209 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9210 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9211 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9212 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9213 ++I;
9214 else {
9215 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9216 Matches.set_size(N);
9217 }
9218 }
9219 }
9220
9221public:
9222 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9223 assert(Matches.empty());
9224 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9225 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9226 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009227 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009228 }
9229
9230 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9231 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9232 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9233 }
9234
9235 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9236 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9237 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9238 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9239 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9240 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9241 }
9242
9243 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9244 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9245 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9246 }
9247
9248 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9249 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9250 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9251 << OvlExpr->getName()
9252 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009253 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009254 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009255
9256 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9257
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009258 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9259
9260 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9261 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9262 return Matches[0].second;
9263 }
9264
9265 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9266 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9267 return &Matches[0].first;
9268 }
9269};
9270
9271/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9272/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9273/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9274/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9275///
9276/// @code
9277/// int f(double);
9278/// int f(int);
9279///
9280/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9281/// @endcode
9282///
9283/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9284/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9285/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9286FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009287Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9288 QualType TargetType,
9289 bool Complain,
9290 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9291 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009292 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009293
9294 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9295 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009296 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9297 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009298 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009299 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9300 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9301 else
9302 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9303 }
9304 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9305 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9306 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9307 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9308 assert(Fn);
9309 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009310 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009311 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009312 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009313
9314 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9315 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009316 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009317}
9318
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009319/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009320/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9321///
9322/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9323/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009324/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009325/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009326FunctionDecl *
9327Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9328 bool Complain,
9329 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009330 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9331 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9332 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009333 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9334 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9335 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009336
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009337 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009338 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009339 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009340
9341 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009342 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009343
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009344 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9345 // whose type matches exactly.
9346 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009347 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9348 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009349 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9350 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009351 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9352 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9353 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009354 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009355 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9356 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009357
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009358 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9359 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9360 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9361 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9362 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9363 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009364 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009365 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009366 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9367 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9368 Specialization, Info)) {
9369 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9370 (void)Result;
9371 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009372 }
9373
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009374 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9375
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009376 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009377 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009378 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009379 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9380 << ovl->getName();
9381 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009382 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009383 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009384 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009385
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009386 Matched = Specialization;
9387 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009388 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009389
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009390 return Matched;
9391}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009392
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009393
9394
9395
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009396// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9397// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9398//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009399// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009400//
9401// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9402// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9403// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9404bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9405 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9406 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009407 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009408 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009409 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009410
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009411 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009412
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009413 DeclAccessPair found;
9414 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9415 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9416 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009417 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009418 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9419 return true;
9420 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009421
9422 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9423 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9424 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9425 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9426 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9427 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9428 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009429 if (!complain) return false;
9430
9431 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9432 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9433 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9434
9435 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9436 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9437 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9438 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9439 // the static candidates were rejected.
9440 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9441 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009442 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009443
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009444 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009445 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009446 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009447
9448 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009449 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009450 SingleFunctionExpression =
9451 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009452 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9453 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9454 return true;
9455 }
9456 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009457 }
9458
9459 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9460 if (complain) {
9461 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9462 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9463 << DestTypeForComplaining
9464 << OpRangeForComplaining
9465 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009466 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9467
9468 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9469 return true;
9470 }
9471
9472 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009473 }
9474
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009475 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9476 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009477}
9478
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009479/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9480static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009481 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009482 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009483 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009484 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009485 bool PartialOverloading,
9486 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009487 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009488 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9489 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9490
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009491 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009492 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9493 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9494 return;
9495 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009496 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9497 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009498 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009499 }
9500
9501 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9502 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009503 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009504 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009505 return;
9506 }
9507
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009508 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009509}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009510
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009511/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9512/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009513void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009514 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009515 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9516 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009517
9518#ifndef NDEBUG
9519 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9520 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009521 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009522 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9523 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9524 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9525 //
9526 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9527 //
9528 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009529 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009530 //
9531 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9532 // template
9533 //
9534 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009535
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009536 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9537 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9538 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9539 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9540 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9541 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9542 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009543 }
9544 }
9545#endif
9546
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009547 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9548 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009549 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009550 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9551 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9552 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9553 }
9554
9555 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9556 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009557 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9558 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9559 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009560
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009561 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009562 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009563 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009564 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009565 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009566}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009567
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009568/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9569/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9570/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9571/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9572///
9573/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9574static bool
9575DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9576 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9577 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009578 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009579 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9580 return false;
9581
9582 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009583 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9584 continue;
9585
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009586 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9587
9588 if (!R.empty()) {
9589 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9590
9591 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9592 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9593 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9594 R.clear();
9595 return false;
9596 }
9597
9598 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9599 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9600 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009601 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009602 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009603
9604 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009605 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009606 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9607 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009608 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009609 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009610 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009611
9612 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9613 // declaring the function there instead.
9614 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9615 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009616 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009617 AssociatedNamespaces,
9618 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009619 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009620 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9621 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9622 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9623 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +00009624 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
9625 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
9626 continue;
9627
9628 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a reserved
9629 // name, like __gnu_cxx.
9630 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9631 if (NS &&
9632 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
9633 continue;
9634
9635 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009636 }
9637
9638 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9639 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009640 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009641 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9642 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9643 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009644 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009645 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9646 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009647 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009648 } else {
9649 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9650 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9651 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9652 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9653 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9654 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9655 }
9656
9657 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9658 return true;
9659 }
9660
9661 R.clear();
9662 }
9663
9664 return false;
9665}
9666
9667/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9668/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9669/// was defined.
9670///
9671/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9672static bool
9673DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9674 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009675 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009676 DeclarationName OpName =
9677 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9678 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9679 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009680 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009681}
9682
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009683namespace {
9684// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9685// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9686// that accept the given number of arguments.
9687class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9688 public:
9689 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9690 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009691 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009692 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9693 }
9694
9695 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9696 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9697 return candidate.isKeyword();
9698
9699 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9700 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9701 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9702 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9703 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9704 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9705 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9706 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9707 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9708 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9709 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9710 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9711 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9712 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9713 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9714 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9715 return true;
9716 }
9717 }
9718 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9719 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9720 return true;
9721 }
9722 return false;
9723 }
9724
9725 private:
9726 unsigned NumArgs;
9727 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9728};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009729
9730// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9731class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9732 public:
9733 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9734 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9735 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9736 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9737 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9738 }
9739
9740 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9741 return false;
9742 }
9743};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009744
9745class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9746 Sema &SemaRef;
9747public:
9748 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9749 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9750 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9751 }
9752
9753 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9754 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9755 }
9756};
9757
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009758}
9759
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009760/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9761///
9762/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009763static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009764BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009765 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9766 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009767 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009768 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009769 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009770 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9771 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9772 //
9773 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9774 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9775 //
9776 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9777 return ExprError();
9778 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009779
9780 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009781 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009782 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009783
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009784 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009785 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009786 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9787 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9788 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9789 }
9790
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009791 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9792 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009793 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009794 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9795 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9796 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9797 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009798 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009799 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009800 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009801 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009802 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009803 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009804
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009805 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9806
9807 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9808 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009809 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009810 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009811 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9812 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009813 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009814 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009815 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009816 else
9817 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9818
9819 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009820 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009821
9822 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009823 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009824 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009825 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009826 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9827 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009828}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009829
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009830/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
9831/// the given function.
9832/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
9833bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9834 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9835 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9836 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9837 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9838 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009839#ifndef NDEBUG
9840 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9841 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9842 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9843
9844 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9845 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9846 FunctionDecl *F;
9847 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9848 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9849 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009850 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009851
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009852 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009853 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009854 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009855#endif
9856
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009857 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009858 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) {
9859 *Result = ExprError();
9860 return true;
9861 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009862
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009863 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9864 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009865 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009866 *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009867
9868 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009869 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9870 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009871 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009872 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9873 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009874 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009875 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009876 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009877 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009878 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
9879 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9880 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9881 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009882 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009883 *Result = Owned(CE);
9884 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009885 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009886 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009887 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009888
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009889 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009890 return false;
9891}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009892
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009893/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
9894/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
9895/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
9896static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9897 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9898 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9899 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9900 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9901 Expr *ExecConfig,
9902 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9903 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
9904 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
9905 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9906 if (CandidateSet->empty())
9907 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9908 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9909 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9910 AllowTypoCorrection);
9911
9912 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009913 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009914 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009915 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
9916 SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
9917 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9918 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9919 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009920 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009921
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009922 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9923 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9924 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009925 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009926 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9927 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009928 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9929 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009930 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9931 return Recovery;
9932
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009933 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009934 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009935 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009936 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9937 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009938 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009939 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009940
9941 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009942 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009943 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009944 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9945 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009946 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009947
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009948 case OR_Deleted: {
9949 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9950 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
9951 << ULE->getName()
9952 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
9953 << Fn->getSourceRange();
9954 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9955 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009956
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009957 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9958 // the call in the AST.
9959 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9960 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9961 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9962 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
9963 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009964 }
9965
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009966 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009967 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009968}
9969
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009970/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
9971/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9972/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9973/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9974/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
9975/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
9976ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9977 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9978 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9979 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9980 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9981 Expr *ExecConfig,
9982 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9983 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
9984 ExprResult result;
9985
9986 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, NumArgs, LParenLoc,
9987 &CandidateSet, &result))
9988 return result;
9989
9990 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9991 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
9992 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
9993
9994 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9995 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
9996 &Best, OverloadResult,
9997 AllowTypoCorrection);
9998}
9999
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010000static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010001 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10002 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10003}
10004
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010005/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10006/// operator.
10007///
10008/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10009///
10010/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10011/// operator.
10012///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010013/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010014/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10015/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10016/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10017/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10018/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10019///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010020/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010021ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010022Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10023 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010024 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010025 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010026
10027 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10028 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10029 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010030 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10031 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010032
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010033 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10034 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010035
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010036 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10037 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010038
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010039 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10040 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10041 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010042 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010043 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010044 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10045 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010046 NumArgs = 2;
10047 }
10048
10049 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010050 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010051 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010052 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010053 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010054 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010055 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010056
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010057 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010058 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010059 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010060 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010061 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10062 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010063 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010064 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010065 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010066 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010067 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010068 }
10069
10070 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010071 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010072
10073 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010074 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
10075 false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010076
10077 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10078 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10079
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010080 // Add candidates from ADL.
10081 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010082 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010083 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10084 CandidateSet);
10085
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010086 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010087 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010088
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010089 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10090
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010091 // Perform overload resolution.
10092 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010093 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010094 case OR_Success: {
10095 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10096 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010097
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010098 if (FnDecl) {
10099 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10100 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010101
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010102 // Convert the arguments.
10103 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010104 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010105
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010106 ExprResult InputRes =
10107 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10108 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10109 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010110 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010111 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010112 } else {
10113 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010114 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010115 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010116 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010117 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010118 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010119 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010120 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010121 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010122 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010123 }
10124
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010125 // Determine the result type.
10126 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10127 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10128 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010129
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010130 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010131 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010132 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010133 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10134 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010135
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010136 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010137 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010138 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010139 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010140 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010141
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010142 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010143 FnDecl))
10144 return ExprError();
10145
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010146 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010147 } else {
10148 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10149 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10150 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010151 ExprResult InputRes =
10152 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10153 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10154 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10155 return ExprError();
10156 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010157 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010158 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010159 }
10160
10161 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010162 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10163 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10164 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010165 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
10166 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010167 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10168 return ExprError();
10169
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010170 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10171 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10172 break;
10173
10174 case OR_Ambiguous:
10175 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10176 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10177 << Input->getType()
10178 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010179 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10180 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010181 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10182 return ExprError();
10183
10184 case OR_Deleted:
10185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10186 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10187 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10188 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10189 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010190 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10191 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010192 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010193 return ExprError();
10194 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010195
10196 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10197 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10198 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010199 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010200}
10201
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010202/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10203/// operator.
10204///
10205/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10206///
10207/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10208/// operator.
10209///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010210/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010211/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10212/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10213/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10214/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10215/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10216///
10217/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10218/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010219ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010220Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010221 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010222 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010223 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010224 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010225 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010226
10227 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10228 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10229 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10230
10231 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10232 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010233 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010234 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010235 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010236 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010237 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010238 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010239 Context.DependentTy,
10240 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010241 OpLoc,
10242 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010243
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010244 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10245 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010246 VK_LValue,
10247 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010248 Context.DependentTy,
10249 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010250 OpLoc,
10251 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010252 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010253
10254 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010255 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010256 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10257 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010258 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010259 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10260 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10261 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010262 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010263 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10264 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10265 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010266 }
10267
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010268 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10269 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10270 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010271
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010272 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10273 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10274 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010275 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10276 return ExprError();
10277
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010278 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10279 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10280 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10281 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10282 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10283 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010284 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010285 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010286
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010287 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10288 // create a built-in binary operator.
10289 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10290 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10291
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010292 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010293 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010294
10295 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010296 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010297
10298 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10299 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10300
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010301 // Add candidates from ADL.
10302 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010303 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010304 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10305 CandidateSet);
10306
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010307 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010308 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010309
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010310 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10311
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010312 // Perform overload resolution.
10313 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010314 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010315 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010316 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10317 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10318
10319 if (FnDecl) {
10320 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10321 // operator.
10322
10323 // Convert the arguments.
10324 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010325 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010326 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010327
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010328 ExprResult Arg1 =
10329 PerformCopyInitialization(
10330 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10331 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10332 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010333 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010334 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010335
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010336 ExprResult Arg0 =
10337 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10338 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10339 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010340 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010341 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010342 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010343 } else {
10344 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010345 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10346 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10347 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10348 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010349 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010350 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010351
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010352 ExprResult Arg1 =
10353 PerformCopyInitialization(
10354 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10355 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10356 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010357 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10358 return ExprError();
10359 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10360 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010361 }
10362
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010363 // Determine the result type.
10364 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10365 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10366 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010367
10368 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010369 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010370 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010371 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010372 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10373 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010374
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010375 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010376 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010377 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10378 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010379
10380 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010381 FnDecl))
10382 return ExprError();
10383
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010384 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10385 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10386 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10387 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10388 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10389 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10390
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010391 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010392 } else {
10393 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10394 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10395 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010396 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10397 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10398 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10399 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010400 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010401 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010402
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010403 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10404 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10405 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10406 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10407 return ExprError();
10408 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010409 break;
10410 }
10411 }
10412
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010413 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10414 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10415 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10416 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10417 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010418 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010419 break;
10420
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010421 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10422 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10423 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010424 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010425 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010426 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010427 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10428 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010429 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010430 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010431 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10432 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10433 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010434 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010435 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10436 return ExprError();
10437
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010438 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10439 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10440 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010441 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010442 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010443 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10444 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010445 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010446 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010447 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010448 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010449
10450 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010451 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010452 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010453 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010454 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010455 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010456 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010457 return ExprError();
10458
10459 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010460 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10461 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10462 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010463 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10464 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010465
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010466 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10467 // explain why it's deleted.
10468 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10469 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010470 } else {
10471 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10472 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10473 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10474 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10475 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10476 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010477 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010478 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010479 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010480 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010481
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010482 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010483 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010484}
10485
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010486ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010487Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10488 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010489 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10490 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010491 DeclarationName OpName =
10492 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10493
10494 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10495 // expression.
10496 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10497
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010498 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010499 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10500 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10501 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010502 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010503 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010504 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010505 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10506 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10507 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010508 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010509
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010510 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010511 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010512 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010513 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010514 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010515 }
10516
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010517 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10518 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10519 return ExprError();
10520 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10521 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010522
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010523 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010524 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010525
10526 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10527
10528 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10529 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10530
10531 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10532 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10533
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010534 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10535
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010536 // Perform overload resolution.
10537 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010538 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010539 case OR_Success: {
10540 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10541 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10542
10543 if (FnDecl) {
10544 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10545 // operator.
10546
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010547 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010548
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010549 // Convert the arguments.
10550 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010551 ExprResult Arg0 =
10552 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10553 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10554 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010555 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010556 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010557
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010558 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010559 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010560 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010561 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010562 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010563 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010564 Owned(Args[1]));
10565 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10566 return ExprError();
10567
10568 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10569
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010570 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010571 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10572 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10573 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010574
10575 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010576 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10577 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010578 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010579 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010580 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010581 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10582 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010583 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10584 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010585
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010586 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10587 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010588 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010589 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10590 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010591
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010592 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010593 FnDecl))
10594 return ExprError();
10595
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010596 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010597 } else {
10598 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10599 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10600 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010601 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10602 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10603 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10604 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010605 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010606 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10607
10608 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10609 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10610 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10611 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10612 return ExprError();
10613 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010614
10615 break;
10616 }
10617 }
10618
10619 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010620 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10621 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10622 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10623 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10624 else
10625 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10626 << Args[0]->getType()
10627 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010628 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010629 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010630 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010631 }
10632
10633 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010634 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010635 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010636 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10637 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010638 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010639 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010640 return ExprError();
10641
10642 case OR_Deleted:
10643 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10644 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010645 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010646 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010647 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010648 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010649 return ExprError();
10650 }
10651
10652 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010653 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010654}
10655
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010656/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10657/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10658/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10659/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10660/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010661/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10662/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010663ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010664Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10665 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010666 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010667 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10668 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10669
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010670 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10671 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010672 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010673
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010674 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10675 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10676 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10677 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10678
10679 QualType fnType =
10680 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10681
10682 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10683 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10684 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10685
10686 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10687 // member function we're calling.
10688 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10689
10690 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10691 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10692 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10693 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10694
10695 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10696 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10697 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10698 if (difference) {
10699 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10700 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10701 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10702 << qualsString
10703 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10704 }
10705
10706 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010707 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10708 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010709 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10710
10711 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010712 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010713 call, 0))
10714 return ExprError();
10715
10716 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10717 return ExprError();
10718
10719 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10720 }
10721
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010722 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10723 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10724 return ExprError();
10725
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010726 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010727 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010728 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010729 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010730 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10731 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010732 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010733 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010734 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010735 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010736 } else {
10737 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010738 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010739
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010740 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010741 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10742 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10743 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010744
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010745 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010746 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010747
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010748 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10749 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10750 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10751 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10752 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10753 }
10754
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010755 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10756 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10757
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010758 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10759 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10760 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10761 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10762
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010763
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010764 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010765 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010766 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10767 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010768 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010769 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10770 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010771 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010772 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010773
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010774 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010775 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010776 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010777 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010778 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010779 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010780 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010781 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010782 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10783 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010784 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010785 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010786 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010787
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010788 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10789
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010790 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10791
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010792 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010793 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010794 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010795 case OR_Success:
10796 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010797 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010798 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010799 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010800 break;
10801
10802 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010803 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010804 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010805 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010806 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10807 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010808 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010809 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010810
10811 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010812 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010813 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010814 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10815 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010816 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010817 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010818
10819 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010820 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010821 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010822 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010823 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010824 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010825 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10826 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010827 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010828 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010829 }
10830
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010831 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010832
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010833 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10834 // non-member call based on that function.
10835 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10836 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10837 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10838 }
10839
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010840 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010841 }
10842
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010843 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10844 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10845 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10846
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010847 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010848 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010849 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10850 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010851 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010852
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010853 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010854 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010855 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010856 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010857
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010858 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010859 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10860 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010861 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10862 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10863 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10864 FoundDecl, Method);
10865 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10866 return ExprError();
10867 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10868 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010869
10870 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010871 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10872 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010873 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010874 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010875 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010876
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010877 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10878
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000010879 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010880 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010881
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010882 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10883 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10884 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10885 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10886
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010887 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010888 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10889 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10890 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10891 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10892
10893 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010894 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010895 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010896 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010897}
10898
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010899/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10900/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10901/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10902/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010903ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010904Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010905 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010906 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010907 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010908 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10909 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010910 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010911
10912 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10913 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10914 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010915
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010916 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10917 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010918
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010919 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10920 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010921 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010922 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10923 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10924 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10925 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010926 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010927 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010928
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010929 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000010930 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010931 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010932
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010933 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10934 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10935 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10936
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010937 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010938 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010939 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10940 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010941 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010942 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010943
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010944 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010945 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10946 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010947 //
10948 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10949 //
10950 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10951 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010952 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10953 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10954 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10955 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010956 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10957 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10958 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10959 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10960 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010961 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
10962 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010963 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010964 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
10965 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010966 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10967 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10968 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10969 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010970
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010971 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10972 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010973 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010974 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010975
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010976 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010977 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10978 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10979 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10980 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10981 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10982 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010983
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010984 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10985 {
10986 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010987 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10988 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010989 }
10990 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010991 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010992
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010993 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10994
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010995 // Perform overload resolution.
10996 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010997 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010998 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010999 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011000 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11001 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011002 break;
11003
11004 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011005 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011006 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011007 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11008 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011009 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011010 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011011 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011012 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011013 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11014 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011015 break;
11016
11017 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011018 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011019 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011020 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011021 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
11022 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011023 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011024
11025 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011026 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011027 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11028 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011029 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011030 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011031 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011032 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11033 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011034 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011035 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011036
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011037 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011038 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011039
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011040 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11041
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011042 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11043 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11044 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011045 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011046 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11047 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11048
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011049 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000011050 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011051
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011052 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11053 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11054 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011055
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011056 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011057 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011058 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11059 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011060 if (Call.isInvalid())
11061 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011062 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11063 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11064 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11065 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011066
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011067 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000011068 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011069 }
11070
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011071 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011072
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011073 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11074 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11075 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11076 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011077
11078 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011079 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011080 return ExprError();
11081
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011082 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11083 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011084
11085 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
11086 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
11087
11088 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11089 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11090 // list).
11091 Expr **MethodArgs;
11092 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
11093 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11094 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11095 } else {
11096 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
11097 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011098 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011099 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
11100 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011101
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011102 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11103 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11104 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011105 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011106 HadMultipleCandidates,
11107 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11108 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011109 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11110 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011111
11112 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11113 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011114 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11115 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11116 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11117
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011118 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011119 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011120 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, NumArgs+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011121 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011122 delete [] MethodArgs;
11123
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011124 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011125 Method))
11126 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011127
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011128 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11129 // slots in the call for them.
11130 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011131 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011132 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
11133 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11134
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011135 bool IsError = false;
11136
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011137 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011138 ExprResult ObjRes =
11139 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11140 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11141 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11142 IsError = true;
11143 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011144 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011145 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011146
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011147 // Check the argument types.
11148 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011149 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011150 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011151 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011152
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011153 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011154
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011155 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011156 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011157 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011158 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011159 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011160
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011161 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11162 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011163 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011164 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011165 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11166 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11167 IsError = true;
11168 break;
11169 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011170
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011171 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011172 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011173
11174 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11175 }
11176
11177 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11178 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11179 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Aaron Ballman4914c282012-07-20 20:40:35 +000011180 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i < NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011181 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11182 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11183 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011184 }
11185 }
11186
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011187 if (IsError) return true;
11188
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011189 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
11190
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011191 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011192 return true;
11193
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011194 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011195}
11196
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011197/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011198/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011199/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011200ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011201Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011202 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11203 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011204
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011205 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11206 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011207
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011208 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11209
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011210 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11211 //
11212 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11213 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11214 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11215 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011216 DeclarationName OpName =
11217 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011218 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011219 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011220
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011221 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011222 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011223 return ExprError();
11224
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011225 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11226 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11227 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011228
11229 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011230 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011231 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
11232 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011233 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011234
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011235 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11236
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011237 // Perform overload resolution.
11238 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011239 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011240 case OR_Success:
11241 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11242 break;
11243
11244 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11245 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11246 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011247 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011248 else
11249 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011250 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011251 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011252 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011253
11254 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011255 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11256 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011257 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011258 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011259
11260 case OR_Deleted:
11261 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11262 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011263 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011264 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011265 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011266 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011267 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011268 }
11269
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011270 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11271
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011272 // Convert the object parameter.
11273 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011274 ExprResult BaseResult =
11275 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11276 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11277 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011278 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011279 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011280
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011281 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011282 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011283 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011284 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11285 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011286
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011287 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11288 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11289 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011290 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011291 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011292 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011293
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011294 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011295 Method))
11296 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011297
11298 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011299}
11300
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011301/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11302/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11303ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11304 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11305 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11306 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11307 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11308 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011309
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011310 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11311 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11312 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011313
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011314 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11315
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011316 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11317 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11318 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11319 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11320 case OR_Success:
11321 case OR_Deleted:
11322 break;
11323
11324 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11325 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11326 << R.getLookupName();
11327 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11328 return ExprError();
11329
11330 case OR_Ambiguous:
11331 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11332 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11333 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011334 }
11335
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011336 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011337 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11338 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011339 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11340 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11341 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11342 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011343
11344 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11345 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011346 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
11347 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
11348 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11349 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11350 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11351 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11352 return true;
11353 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11354 }
11355
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011356 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11357 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11358 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11359
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011360 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011361 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11362 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011363 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11364
11365 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11366 return ExprError();
11367
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011368 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011369 return ExprError();
11370
11371 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11372}
11373
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011374/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11375/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11376/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11377/// dependent lookup.
11378/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11379/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11380/// is returned.
11381Sema::ForRangeStatus
11382Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11383 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11384 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11385 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11386 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11387 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11388 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11389 CandidateSet->clear();
11390 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11391 ExprResult MemberRef =
11392 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11393 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11394 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11395 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11396 MemberLookup,
11397 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11398 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11399 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11400 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11401 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11402 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11403 }
11404 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, MultiExprArg(), Loc, 0);
11405 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11406 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11407 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11408 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11409 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11410 }
11411 } else {
11412 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011413 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11414 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11415 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11416 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011417 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011418
11419 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, &Range, 1, Loc,
11420 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11421 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11422 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11423 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11424 }
11425 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11426 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11427 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11428
11429 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11430 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11431 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11432 }
11433 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, &Range, 1,
11434 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11435 OverloadResult,
11436 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11437 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11438 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11439 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11440 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11441 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11442 }
11443 }
11444 return FRS_Success;
11445}
11446
11447
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011448/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11449/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11450/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11451/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011452/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011453Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011454 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011455 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011456 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11457 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011458 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011459 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011460
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011461 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011462 }
11463
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011464 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011465 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11466 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011467 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011468 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011469 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011470 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011471 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011472 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011473
11474 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011475 ICE->getCastKind(),
11476 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011477 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011478 }
11479
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011480 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011481 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011482 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011483 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11484 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11485 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11486 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011487 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011488 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11489 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11490 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011491 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11492 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011493 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011494 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011495
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011496 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11497 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11498 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11499 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11500
11501 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11502 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11503 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11504 QualType ClassType
11505 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11506 QualType MemPtrType
11507 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11508
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011509 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11510 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11511 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011512 }
11513 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011514 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11515 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011516 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011517 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011518
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011519 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011520 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011521 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011522 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011523 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011524
11525 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011526 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11527 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011528 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011529 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11530 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011531 }
11532
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011533 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11534 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011535 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011536 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011537 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011538 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11539 Fn->getType(),
11540 VK_LValue,
11541 Found.getDecl(),
11542 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011543 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011544 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11545 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011546 }
11547
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011548 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011549 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011550 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11551 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11552 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11553 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11554 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011555
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011556 Expr *Base;
11557
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011558 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11559 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011560 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11561 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011562 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11563 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011564 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011565 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011566 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011567 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11568 Fn->getType(),
11569 VK_LValue,
11570 Found.getDecl(),
11571 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011572 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011573 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11574 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011575 } else {
11576 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11577 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011578 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011579 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011580 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11581 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11582 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11583 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011584 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011585 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011586
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011587 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11588 QualType type;
11589 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11590 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11591 type = Fn->getType();
11592 } else {
11593 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11594 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11595 }
11596
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011597 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11598 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11599 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011600 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011601 Fn,
11602 Found,
11603 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11604 TemplateArgs,
11605 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11606 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011607 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011608 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011609 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011610
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011611 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011612}
11613
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011614ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011615 DeclAccessPair Found,
11616 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011617 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011618}
11619
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011620} // end namespace clang